blob: 1253357b0a6426f87dcb5118f25e1d4f5bf9eff7 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreauffb89472012-05-14 07:26:56 +02007 2012/05/13
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
17 This document is formated with 80 columns per line, with even number of
18 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100565. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020057
586. HTTP header manipulation
59
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100607. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200617.1. Matching integers
627.2. Matching strings
637.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +0200647.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200657.5. Available matching criteria
667.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
677.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
687.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
697.6. Pre-defined ACLs
707.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100717.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020072
738. Logging
748.1. Log levels
758.2. Log formats
768.2.1. Default log format
778.2.2. TCP log format
788.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100798.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200808.3. Advanced logging options
818.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
828.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
838.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
848.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
858.4. Timing events
868.5. Session state at disconnection
878.6. Non-printable characters
888.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
898.8. Capturing HTTP headers
908.9. Examples of logs
91
929. Statistics and monitoring
939.1. CSV format
949.2. Unix Socket commands
95
96
971. Quick reminder about HTTP
98----------------------------
99
100When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
101fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
102on almost anything found in the contents.
103
104However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
105formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
106correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
107
108
1091.1. The HTTP transaction model
110-------------------------------
111
112The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100113to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
115connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
116will involve a new connection :
117
118 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
119
120In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
121establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
122by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
123length.
124
125Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
126to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
127however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
128response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
129header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
130
131 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
132
133Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
134power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
135but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200136a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137
138A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
139keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
140second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
141page :
142
143 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
144
145This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
146latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
147correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
148the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100149server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
152connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
153everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
154established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
155sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
156while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
157another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
158sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
159http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
160mode.
161
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162
1631.2. HTTP request
164-----------------
165
166First, let's consider this HTTP request :
167
168 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100169 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
171 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
172 3 User-agent: my small browser
173 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
174 5 Accept: image/png
175
176
1771.2.1. The Request line
178-----------------------
179
180Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
181
182 - a METHOD : GET
183 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
184 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
185
186All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
187which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
188followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
189is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
190desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
191the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
192
193The URI itself can have several forms :
194
195 - A "relative URI" :
196
197 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
198
199 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
200 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
201
202 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
203
204 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
205
206 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
207 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
208 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
209 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
210 must accept this form too.
211
212 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
213 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
214 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100215
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
217 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
218 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
219 other protocols too.
220
221In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
222mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
223on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
224It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
225specific to the language, framework or application in use.
226
227
2281.2.2. The request headers
229--------------------------
230
231The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
232beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
233an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
234Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
235values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
236encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
237the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
238define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
239
240Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
241their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
242"Connection:" header).
243
244The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
245that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
246is one valid form of empty line.
247
248Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
249headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
250about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
251application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
252
253Important note:
254 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
255 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
256 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
257 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
258
259
2601.3. HTTP response
261------------------
262
263An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
264messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
265
266 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100267 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200268 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
269 2 Content-length: 350
270 3 Content-Type: text/html
271
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200272As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
273codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
274response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100275continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
276the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
277following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
278sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
279(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
280correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
281such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
282state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
283over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
284if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
285information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
2881.3.1. The Response line
289------------------------
290
291Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
292
293 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
294 - a status code : 200
295 - a reason : OK
296
297The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200298 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
300 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
301 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
302 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
303
304Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100305"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200306found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
307messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
308or "Authentication Required".
309
310Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
311
312 Code When / reason
313 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
314 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
316 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
317 400 for an invalid or too large request
318 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
319 accessing the stats page)
320 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
321 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
322 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
323 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
324 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
325 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
326 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
327 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
328 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
329
330The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3314.2).
332
333
3341.3.2. The response headers
335---------------------------
336
337Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
338the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
339details.
340
341
3422. Configuring HAProxy
343----------------------
344
3452.1. Configuration file format
346------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200347
348HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
349
350 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
351 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
352 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
353 "frontend" and "backend".
354
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100355The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
356referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
357delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100358preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100359escaped by doubling them.
360
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
3622.2. Time format
363----------------
364
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100365Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100366values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
367otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
368numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
369for every keyword. Supported units are :
370
371 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
372 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
373 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
374 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
375 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
376 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
377
378
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003792.3. Examples
380-------------
381
382 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
383 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
384 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
385 global
386 daemon
387 maxconn 256
388
389 defaults
390 mode http
391 timeout connect 5000ms
392 timeout client 50000ms
393 timeout server 50000ms
394
395 frontend http-in
396 bind *:80
397 default_backend servers
398
399 backend servers
400 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
401
402
403 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
404 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
405 global
406 daemon
407 maxconn 256
408
409 defaults
410 mode http
411 timeout connect 5000ms
412 timeout client 50000ms
413 timeout server 50000ms
414
415 listen http-in
416 bind *:80
417 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
418
419
420Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
421
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100422 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200423
424
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004253. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200426--------------------
427
428Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
429are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
430of them have command-line equivalents.
431
432The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
433
434 * Process management and security
435 - chroot
436 - daemon
437 - gid
438 - group
439 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100440 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200441 - nbproc
442 - pidfile
443 - uid
444 - ulimit-n
445 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200446 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200447 - node
448 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100449 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100450
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200451 * Performance tuning
452 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200453 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100454 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 - noepoll
456 - nokqueue
457 - nopoll
458 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100459 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200460 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200461 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200462 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200463 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100464 - tune.maxaccept
465 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200466 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200467 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100468 - tune.rcvbuf.client
469 - tune.rcvbuf.server
470 - tune.sndbuf.client
471 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100472
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200473 * Debugging
474 - debug
475 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200476
477
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004783.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200479------------------------------------
480
481chroot <jail dir>
482 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
483 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
484 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
485 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
486 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
487 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100488
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200489daemon
490 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
491 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
492 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
493
494gid <number>
495 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
496 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
497 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
498 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100499
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200500group <group name>
501 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
502 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100503
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200504log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200505 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
506 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100507 configured with "log global".
508
509 <address> can be one of:
510
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100511 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100512 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
513 port).
514
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100515 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
516 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
517 port).
518
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100519 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
520 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
521 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
522 writeable).
523
524 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200525
526 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
527 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
528 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
529
530 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200531 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
532 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
533 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
534 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
535 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
536 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200538 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200539
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100540log-send-hostname [<string>]
541 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
542 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
543 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
544 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
545 the logs.
546
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000547log-tag <string>
548 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
549 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
550 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
551 running on the same host.
552
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200553nbproc <number>
554 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
555 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
556 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
557 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
558 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
559
560pidfile <pidfile>
561 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
562 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
563 starting the process. See also "daemon".
564
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200565stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>]
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200566 [level <level>]
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200567
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200568 Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously
569 existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100570 will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200571 issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
572
573 An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of
574 the commands that can be issued on the socket :
575 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
576 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
577 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
578
579 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +0200580 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200581 counters).
582
583 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
584 all counters).
Willy Tarreaua8efd362008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100585
586 On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this
587 socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and
588 group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to
589 restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode"
590 keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on
591 the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the
592 user the process is started with.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200593
594stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
595 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
596 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100597 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200598
599stats maxconn <connections>
600 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
601 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
602
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200603uid <number>
604 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
605 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
606 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
607 one. See also "gid" and "user".
608
609ulimit-n <number>
610 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
611 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
612 option.
613
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100614unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
615 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
616
617 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
618 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
619 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
620 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
621 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
622 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
623 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
624 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
625 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
626 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
627
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200628user <user name>
629 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
630 See also "uid" and "group".
631
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200632node <name>
633 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
634
635 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
636 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
637 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
638 traffic.
639
640description <text>
641 Add a text that describes the instance.
642
643 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
644 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
645 "<" and ">" characters.
646
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200647
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006483.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200649-----------------------
650
651maxconn <number>
652 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
653 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
654 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
655 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
656
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200657maxconnrate <number>
658 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
659 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
660 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
661 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
662 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
663 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
664 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
665 fairness.
666
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100667maxpipes <number>
668 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
669 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
670 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
671 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
672 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
673 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
674
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200675noepoll
676 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
677 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
678 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
679
680nokqueue
681 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
682 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
683 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
684
685nopoll
686 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
687 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100688 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200689 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
690 "nokqueue".
691
692nosepoll
693 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
694 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
695 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
696
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100697nosplice
698 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
699 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
700 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100701 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100702 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
703 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
704 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
705 "option splice-response".
706
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200707spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
708 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
709 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
710 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
711 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
712 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
713
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200714tune.bufsize <number>
715 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
716 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
717 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
718 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
719 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
720 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
721 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
722 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
723
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200724tune.chksize <number>
725 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
726 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
727 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
728 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
729 checks whenever possible.
730
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200731tune.http.maxhdr <number>
732 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
733 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
734 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
735 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
736 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
737 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
738 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
739 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
740 limit too high.
741
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100742tune.maxaccept <number>
743 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
744 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
745 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100746 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100747 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
748 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100749 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100750 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
751
752tune.maxpollevents <number>
753 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
754 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
755 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
756 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
757 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
758
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200759tune.maxrewrite <number>
760 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
761 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
762 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
763 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
764 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
765 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
766 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
767 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
768 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
769 bufsize.
770
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200771tune.pipesize <number>
772 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
773 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
774 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
775 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
776 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
777 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
778
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100779tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
780tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
781 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
782 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
783 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
784 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
785 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
786 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
787 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
788
789tune.sndbuf.client <number>
790tune.sndbuf.server <number>
791 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
792 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
793 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
794 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
795 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
796 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
797 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
798 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
799 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
800 notifying haproxy again.
801
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200802
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008033.3. Debugging
804--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200805
806debug
807 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
808 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
809 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
810 system startup.
811
812quiet
813 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
814 line argument "-q".
815
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200816
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008173.4. Userlists
818--------------
819It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
820http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
821it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
822
823userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100824 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100825 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
826
827group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100828 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100829 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
830 proceeded by "users" keyword.
831
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100832user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
833 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100834 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
835 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100836 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
837 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100838 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
839 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
840
841
842 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100843 userlist L1
844 group G1 users tiger,scott
845 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100846
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100847 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
848 user scott insecure-password elgato
849 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100850
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100851 userlist L2
852 group G1
853 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100854
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100855 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
856 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
857 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100858
859 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200860
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200861
8623.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200863----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200864It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
865haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
866pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
867identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
868or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
869Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
870known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
871the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
872process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
873during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
874tables.
875
876peers <peersect>
877 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independant section,
878 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
879
880peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
881 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
882 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
883 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
884 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
885 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
886 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
887
888 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
889 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
890
891 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
892 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
893 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
894 across all peers.
895
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200896 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200897 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100898 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
899 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
900 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200901
902 backend mybackend
903 mode tcp
904 balance roundrobin
905 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
906 stick on src
907
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +0100908 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
909 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +0200910
911
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009124. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200913----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100914
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200915Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
916 - defaults <name>
917 - frontend <name>
918 - backend <name>
919 - listen <name>
920
921A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
922its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
923section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100924section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200925
926A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
927connections.
928
929A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
930to forward incoming connections.
931
932A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
933parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
934
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100935All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
936'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
937case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
938
939Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
940logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
941proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
942However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
943name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
944
945Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
946and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100947bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100948protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
949modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
950arbitrary criteria.
951
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100952
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
954--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200956The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
957limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
958they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
959limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100960marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200961option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200962and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
963with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
964specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100965
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200966
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100967 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
968------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
969acl - X X X
970appsession - - X X
971backlog X X X -
972balance X - X X
973bind - X X -
974bind-process X X X X
975block - X X X
976capture cookie - X X -
977capture request header - X X -
978capture response header - X X -
979clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
980contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
981cookie X - X X
982default-server X - X X
983default_backend X X X -
984description - X X X
985disabled X X X X
986dispatch - - X X
987enabled X X X X
988errorfile X X X X
989errorloc X X X X
990errorloc302 X X X X
991-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
992errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200993force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100994fullconn X - X X
995grace X X X X
996hash-type X - X X
997http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100998http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200999http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001000http-request - X X X
1001id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001002ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001003log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001004maxconn X X X -
1005mode X X X X
1006monitor fail - X X -
1007monitor-net X X X -
1008monitor-uri X X X -
1009option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1010option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1011option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1012option allbackups (*) X - X X
1013option checkcache (*) X - X X
1014option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1015option contstats (*) X X X -
1016option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1017option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1018option forceclose (*) X X X X
1019-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1020option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001021option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001022option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001023option http-server-close (*) X X X X
1024option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1025option httpchk X - X X
1026option httpclose (*) X X X X
1027option httplog X X X X
1028option http_proxy (*) X X X X
1029option independant-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001030option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001031option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1032option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1033option logasap (*) X X X -
1034option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001035option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001036option nolinger (*) X X X X
1037option originalto X X X X
1038option persist (*) X - X X
1039option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001040option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001041option smtpchk X - X X
1042option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1043option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1044option splice-request (*) X X X X
1045option splice-response (*) X X X X
1046option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1047option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1048-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1049option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1050option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1051option tcpka X X X X
1052option tcplog X X X X
1053option transparent (*) X - X X
1054persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1055rate-limit sessions X X X -
1056redirect - X X X
1057redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1058redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1059reqadd - X X X
1060reqallow - X X X
1061reqdel - X X X
1062reqdeny - X X X
1063reqiallow - X X X
1064reqidel - X X X
1065reqideny - X X X
1066reqipass - X X X
1067reqirep - X X X
1068reqisetbe - X X X
1069reqitarpit - X X X
1070reqpass - X X X
1071reqrep - X X X
1072-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1073reqsetbe - X X X
1074reqtarpit - X X X
1075retries X - X X
1076rspadd - X X X
1077rspdel - X X X
1078rspdeny - X X X
1079rspidel - X X X
1080rspideny - X X X
1081rspirep - X X X
1082rsprep - X X X
1083server - - X X
1084source X - X X
1085srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001086stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001087stats auth X - X X
1088stats enable X - X X
1089stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001090stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001091stats realm X - X X
1092stats refresh X - X X
1093stats scope X - X X
1094stats show-desc X - X X
1095stats show-legends X - X X
1096stats show-node X - X X
1097stats uri X - X X
1098-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1099stick match - - X X
1100stick on - - X X
1101stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001102stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001103stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001104tcp-request connection - X X -
1105tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001106tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001107tcp-response content - - X X
1108tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001109timeout check X - X X
1110timeout client X X X -
1111timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1112timeout connect X - X X
1113timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1114timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1115timeout http-request X X X X
1116timeout queue X - X X
1117timeout server X - X X
1118timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1119timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001120timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001121transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001122unique-id-format X X X -
1123unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001124use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001125use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001126------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1127 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001128
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011304.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1131---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001132
1133This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1134
1135
1136acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1137 Declare or complete an access list.
1138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1139 no | yes | yes | yes
1140 Example:
1141 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1142 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1143 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1144
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001145 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001146
1147
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001148appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1149 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001150 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1152 no | no | yes | yes
1153 Arguments :
1154 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1155 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1156
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001157 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001158 checked in each cookie value.
1159
1160 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1161 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1162 milliseconds.
1163
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001164 request-learn
1165 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1166 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1167 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1168 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1169 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1170 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1171
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001172 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1173 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1174 data following this prefix.
1175
1176 Example :
1177 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1178
1179 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1180 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1181
1182 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1183 2 modes are currently supported :
1184 - path-parameters :
1185 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1186 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1187 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1188 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1189 - query-string :
1190 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1191 query string.
1192
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001193 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1194 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1195 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1196 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001197 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1198 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1199 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001200 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1201 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1202
1203 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1204
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001205 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1206 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1207 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1208
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001209 Example :
1210 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1211
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001212 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1213 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001214
1215
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001216backlog <conns>
1217 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1219 yes | yes | yes | no
1220 Arguments :
1221 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1222 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001223 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001224
1225 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1226 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1227 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1228 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1229 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1230 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1231 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1232 backlog parameter.
1233
1234 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1235 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1236 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1237
1238 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1239
1240
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001241balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001242balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001243 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1245 yes | no | yes | yes
1246 Arguments :
1247 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1248 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1249 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1250 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1251
1252 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1253 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1254 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1255 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001256 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1257 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1258 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1259 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1260 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1261 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1262 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1263 it, so that you don't worry.
1264
1265 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1266 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1267 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1268 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1269 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1270 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1271 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1272 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001273
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001274 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1275 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1276 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1277 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1278 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1279 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1280 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1281 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1282
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001283 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
1284 connection. The servers are choosen from the lowest numeric
1285 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1286 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001287 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001288 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1289 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1290 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1291 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1292 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001293 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1294 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1295 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1296 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1297 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1298 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001299
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001300 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1301 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1302 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1303 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1304 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1305 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1306 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1307 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001308 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001309 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001310 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1311 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1312 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001313
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001314 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1315 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1316 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1317 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1318 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1319 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1320 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1321 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1322 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1323 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1324 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1325 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001326
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001327 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001328 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1329 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1330 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1331 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1332 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1333 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1334 URIs start with a leading "/".
1335
1336 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1337 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1338 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1339 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1340
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001341 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001342 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1343
1344 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001345 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1346 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
1347 ('?') in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1348 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1349 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1350 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1351 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1352 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1353 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1354 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1355 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1356 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1357 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1358 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1359 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1360 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1361 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1362 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1363 be randomly balanced if at all.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001364
1365 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1366 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1367 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1368 server will receive the request.
1369
1370 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1371 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1372 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1373 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1374 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001375 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1376 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1377 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001378
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001379 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1380 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1381 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1382 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1383 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001384
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001385 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001386 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1387 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1388 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1389
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001390 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1391 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1392 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1393
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001394 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001395 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001396 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1397 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1398 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1399 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1400 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1401 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001402 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001403 used instead.
1404
1405 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1406 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1407 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1408 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1409
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001410 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1411 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1412 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1413
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001414 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001415
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001416 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001417 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1418 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001419
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001420 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001421 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001422
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001423 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1424 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1425 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001426
1427 Examples :
1428 balance roundrobin
1429 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001430 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001431 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1432 balance hdr(host)
1433 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001434
1435 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1436 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1437
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001438 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001439 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1440 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1441 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1442 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1443
1444 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1445 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1446 defaults to 16 kB.
1447
1448 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1449 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1450
1451 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1452 Round Robin.
1453
1454 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1455 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1456 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1457 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1458
1459 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1460
1461 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001462 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001463 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1464 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1465 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001466
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001467 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1468 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001469
1470
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001471bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...]
1472bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface>
1473bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg>
1474bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent
1475bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id>
1476bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name>
1477bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001478bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] accept-proxy
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001479bind /<path> [, ...]
1480bind /<path> [, ...] mode <mode>
1481bind /<path> [, ...] [ user <user> | uid <uid> ]
1482bind /<path> [, ...] [ group <user> | gid <gid> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001483 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1485 no | yes | yes | no
1486 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001487 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1488 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1489 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1490 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001491 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001492
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001493 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1494 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001495 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1496 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1497 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001498 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1499 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1500 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1501 the range.
1502
1503 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1504 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1505 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1506 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1507 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1508 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1509 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
1510 privileges to start the program, which are independant of
1511 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001512
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001513 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1514 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1515 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1516 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1517 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1518 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1519 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1520 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1521
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001522 <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently
1523 only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical
1524 interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all
1525 addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the
1526 incoming packet physically come through the designated
1527 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to
1528 the same address if they are bound to different interfaces.
1529 Note that binding to a physical interface requires root
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001530 privileges. This parameter is only compatible with TCP
1531 sockets.
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001532
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001533 <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be
1534 advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force
1535 a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for
1536 connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a
1537 kernel feature which is theorically supported under Linux but
1538 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not
Willy Tarreau48a7e722010-12-24 15:26:39 +01001539 work on other operating systems. It may also not change the
1540 advertised value but change the effective size of outgoing
1541 segments. The commonly advertised value on Ethernet networks
1542 is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is positive,
1543 it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it
1544 will indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's
1545 advertised MSS for outgoing segments. This parameter is only
1546 compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001547
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02001548 <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and
1549 unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be
1550 assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a
1551 single socket.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001552
1553 <name> is an optional name provided for stats
1554
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001555 <mode> is the octal mode used to define access permissions on the
1556 UNIX socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1557 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1558 simply ignore this.
1559
1560 <user> is the name of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1561 socket. It can also be set by default in the global
1562 section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms
1563 simply ignore this.
1564
1565 <group> is the name of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1566 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1567 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1568 this.
1569
1570 <uid> is the uid of user that will be marked owner of the UNIX
1571 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1572 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1573 this.
1574
1575 <gid> is the gid of a group that will be used to create the UNIX
1576 socket. It can also be set by default in the global section's
1577 "unix-bind" statement. Note that some platforms simply ignore
1578 this.
1579
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001580 transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
1581 Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound
1582 even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001583 targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001584 the address was locally configured. This normally requires
1585 that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with
1586 the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for
1587 the specified port. This keyword is available only when
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001588 HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1. This parameter is
1589 only compatible with TCP sockets.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001590
Willy Tarreau59f89202010-10-02 11:54:00 +02001591 defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
Willy Tarreaucb6cd432009-10-13 07:34:14 +02001592 Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be
1593 accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the
1594 first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for
1595 which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly
1596 improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is
1597 already available when the connection is accepted. On the
1598 other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which
1599 don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
1600 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is
1601 never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues
1602 with front firewalls which would see an established
1603 connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV.
1604
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001605 accept-proxy is an optional keyword which enforces use of the PROXY
1606 protocol over any connection accepted by this listener. The
1607 PROXY protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of the
1608 incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used,
1609 with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules
1610 which will only see the real connection address. Logs will
1611 reflect the addresses indicated in the protocol, unless it is
1612 violated, in which case the real address will still be used.
1613 This keyword combined with support from external components
1614 can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
1615 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and
1616 not even always usable.
1617
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001618 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1619 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1620 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1621 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1622 in a frontend.
1623
1624 Example :
1625 listen http_proxy
1626 bind :80,:443
1627 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001628 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001629
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001630 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreau71c814e2010-10-29 21:56:16 +02001631 documentation.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001632
1633
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001634bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1635 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1637 yes | yes | yes | yes
1638 Arguments :
1639 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1640 may be used to override a default value.
1641
1642 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1643 option may be combined with other numbers.
1644
1645 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1646 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1647 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1648 missing from all processes.
1649
1650 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1651 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1652 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1653 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1654
1655 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1656 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1657 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1658 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1659 and 'even' instances.
1660
1661 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1662 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1663 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1664 32.
1665
1666 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1667 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1668
1669 Example :
1670 listen app_ip1
1671 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001672 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001673
1674 listen app_ip2
1675 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001676 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001677
1678 listen management
1679 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001680 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001681
1682 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1683
1684
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001685block { if | unless } <condition>
1686 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1688 no | yes | yes | yes
1689
1690 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1691 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001692 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001693 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001694 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1695 "block" statements per instance.
1696
1697 Example:
1698 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1699 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1700 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1701 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1702
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001703 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001704
1705
1706capture cookie <name> len <length>
1707 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1709 no | yes | yes | no
1710 Arguments :
1711 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1712 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1713 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1714 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1715 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1716
1717 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1718 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1719 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1720 right if it exceeds <length>.
1721
1722 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1723 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1724 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1725 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1726
1727 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1728 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1729 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1730
1731 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1732 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1733 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1734 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001735 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001736 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1737
1738 Example:
1739 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1740
1741 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001742 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001743
1744
1745capture request header <name> len <length>
1746 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1748 no | yes | yes | no
1749 Arguments :
1750 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001751 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001752 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1753 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1754 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1755
1756 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1757 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1758 it exceeds <length>.
1759
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001760 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001761 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1762 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001763 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1764 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1765 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1766 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001767 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001768 environments to find where the request came from.
1769
1770 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1771 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1772 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1773 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001774
1775 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1776 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1777 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1778 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1779
1780 Example:
1781 capture request header Host len 15
1782 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1783 capture request header Referrer len 15
1784
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001785 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001786 about logging.
1787
1788
1789capture response header <name> len <length>
1790 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1792 no | yes | yes | no
1793 Arguments :
1794 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001795 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001796 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1797 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1798 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1799
1800 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1801 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1802 it exceeds <length>.
1803
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001804 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001805 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1806 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1807 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001808 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1809 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1810 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1811 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001812
1813 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1814 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1815 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1816 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1817
1818 Example:
1819 capture response header Content-length len 9
1820 capture response header Location len 15
1821
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001822 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001823 about logging.
1824
1825
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001826clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001827 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1829 yes | yes | yes | no
1830 Arguments :
1831 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1832 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1833 as explained at the top of this document.
1834
1835 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1836 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1837 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1838 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1839 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1840 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1841 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1842 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001843 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001844 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1845 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1846
1847 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1848 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1849 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1850 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1851 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1852 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1853
1854 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1855 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1856
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001857 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1858 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001859
1860
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001861contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001862 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1864 yes | no | yes | yes
1865 Arguments :
1866 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1867 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1868 as explained at the top of this document.
1869
1870 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001871 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001872 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001873 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1874 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1875 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1876 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1877
1878 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1879 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1880 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1881 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1882 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1883 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1884
1885 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1886 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1887 instead.
1888
1889 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1890 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1891
1892
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001893cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001894 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ domain <domain> ]*
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001895 [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001896 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1898 yes | no | yes | yes
1899 Arguments :
1900 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1901 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1902 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1903 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1904 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1905 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1906 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1907 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1908 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1909
1910 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1911 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1912 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1913 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1914 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1915 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1916 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1917 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1918 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1919 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1920 "insert" and "prefix".
1921
1922 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001923 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001924
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001925 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001926 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
1927 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
1928 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
1929 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
1930 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
1931 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
1932 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
1933 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
1934 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
1935 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001936
1937 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1938 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1939 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1940 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1941 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1942 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1943 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1944 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1945 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1946 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001947 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
1948 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
1949 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001950
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001951 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1952 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1953 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001954 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
1955 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
1956 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
1957 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02001958 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
1959 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
1960 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001961
1962 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1963 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1964 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1965 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1966 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1967 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1968 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1969 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1970 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1971
1972 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1973 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1974 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1975 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1976 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1977 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1978 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1979 persistence cookie in the cache.
1980 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1981
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02001982 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
1983 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
1984 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
1985 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
1986 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
1987 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
1988 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
1989 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
1990 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
1991 they logout.
1992
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001993 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001994 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001995 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1996 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1997 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1998 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1999 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2000 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002001
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002002 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2003 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2004 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2005 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2006 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2007 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2008 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2009 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2010 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2011 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2012 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2013 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2014 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2015 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2016 the site.
2017
2018 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2019 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2020 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2021 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2022 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2023 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2024 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2025 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2026 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2027 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2028 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2029 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2030 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2031 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2032 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2033 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2034
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002035 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2036 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2037 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2038 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002039
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002040 Examples :
2041 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2042 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2043 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002044 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002045
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002046 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002047 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002048
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002049
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002050default-server [param*]
2051 Change default options for a server in a backend
2052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2053 yes | no | yes | yes
2054 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002055 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2056 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2057 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2058 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002059
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002060 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002061 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2062
2063 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002064
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002065
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002066default_backend <backend>
2067 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2068 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2069 yes | yes | yes | no
2070 Arguments :
2071 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2072
2073 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2074 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2075 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2076 will catch all undetermined requests.
2077
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002078 Example :
2079
2080 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2081 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2082 default_backend dynamic
2083
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002084 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2085
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002086
2087disabled
2088 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2090 yes | yes | yes | yes
2091 Arguments : none
2092
2093 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2094 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2095 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2096 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2097 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2098 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2099 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2100
2101 See also : "enabled"
2102
2103
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002104dispatch <address>:<port>
2105 Set a default server address
2106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2107 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002108 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002109
2110 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2111 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2112 during start-up.
2113
2114 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2115 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2116 possible with normal servers.
2117
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002118 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002119 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2120 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2121 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2122 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2123
2124 See also : "server"
2125
2126
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002127enabled
2128 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2130 yes | yes | yes | yes
2131 Arguments : none
2132
2133 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2134 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2135
2136 See also : "disabled"
2137
2138
2139errorfile <code> <file>
2140 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2142 yes | yes | yes | yes
2143 Arguments :
2144 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002145 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002146
2147 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002148 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002149 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002150 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2151 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002152
2153 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2154 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2155 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2156
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002157 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2158
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002159 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2160 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2161 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2162 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2163
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002164 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2165 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2166 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2167 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2168 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2169 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2170
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002171 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2172 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2173 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002174 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002175 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2176
2177 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2178
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002179 Example :
2180 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
2181 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2182 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2183
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002184
2185errorloc <code> <url>
2186errorloc302 <code> <url>
2187 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2189 yes | yes | yes | yes
2190 Arguments :
2191 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002192 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002193
2194 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2195 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2196 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2197 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2198 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2199
2200 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2201 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2202 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2203
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002204 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2205
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002206 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2207 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2208 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2209 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2210 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2211 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2212 request.
2213
2214 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2215
2216
2217errorloc303 <code> <url>
2218 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2220 yes | yes | yes | yes
2221 Arguments :
2222 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2223 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2224
2225 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2226 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2227 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2228 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2229 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2230
2231 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2232 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2233 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2234
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002235 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2236
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002237 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2238 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2239 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2240 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002241 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002242
2243 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2244
2245
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002246force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2247 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2248 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2249 no | yes | yes | yes
2250
2251 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2252 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2253 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2254 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2255 marked down for maintenance operations.
2256
2257 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2258 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2259 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2260 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2261 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2262 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2263 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2264 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2265 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2266
2267 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2268 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2269 is used.
2270
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002271 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002272 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002273
2274
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002275fullconn <conns>
2276 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2278 yes | no | yes | yes
2279 Arguments :
2280 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2281 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2282
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002283 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002284 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002285 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002286 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2287 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2288 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2289 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2290 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002291 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002292
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002293 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2294 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
2295 backend. That way it's safe to leave it unset.
2296
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002297 Example :
2298 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2299 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2300 # connections.
2301 backend dynamic
2302 fullconn 10000
2303 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2304 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2305
2306 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2307
2308
2309grace <time>
2310 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002312 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002313 Arguments :
2314 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2315 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2316 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2317
2318 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2319 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002320 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002321 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2322
2323 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2324 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2325 simplify it.
2326
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002327
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002328hash-type <method>
2329 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2331 yes | no | yes | yes
2332 Arguments :
2333 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2334 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2335 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2336 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2337 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2338 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2339 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2340 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2341 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2342
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002343 avalanche this mechanism uses the default map-based hashing described
2344 above but applies a full avalanche hash before performing the
2345 mapping. The result is a slightly less smooth hash for most
2346 situations, but the hash becomes better than pure map-based
2347 hashes when the number of servers is a multiple of the size of
2348 the input set. When using URI hash with a number of servers
2349 multiple of 64, it's desirable to change the hash type to
2350 this value.
2351
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002352 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2353 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2354 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2355 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2356 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2357 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2358 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2359 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2360 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2361 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2362 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2363 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2364 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2365
2366 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2367
2368 See also : "balance", "server"
2369
2370
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002371http-check disable-on-404
2372 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002374 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002375 Arguments : none
2376
2377 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2378 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2379 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2380 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2381 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2382 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2383 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2384 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002385 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2386 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2387 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2388
2389 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2390
2391
2392http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2393 Make HTTP health checks consider reponse contents or specific status codes
2394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002395 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002396 Arguments :
2397 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2398 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002399 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceeded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002400 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2401 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2402 details on the supported keywords.
2403
2404 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2405 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2406 with the usual backslash ('\').
2407
2408 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2409 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2410 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2411 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2412 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2413
2414 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
2415 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2416 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2417 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2418 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2419
2420 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
2421 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2422 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2423 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2424 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2425 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2426
2427 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
2428 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2429 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2430 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2431 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2432 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2433 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2434 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2435 trace).
2436
2437 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
2438 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2439 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2440 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2441 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2442 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2443 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2444 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2445
2446 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2447 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2448 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2449 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2450 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2451 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2452 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2453 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2454
2455 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2456 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2457
2458 Examples :
2459 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002460 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002461
2462 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002463 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002464
2465 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002466 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002467
2468 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002469 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002470
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002471 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002472
2473
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002474http-check send-state
2475 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2477 yes | no | yes | yes
2478 Arguments : none
2479
2480 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2481 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2482 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2483 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2484 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2485
2486 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2487 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2488 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2489 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2490 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2491 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2492 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2493 checked in multiple backends.
2494
2495 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2496 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2497
2498 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2499 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2500 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2501 one fails.
2502
2503 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2504 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2505 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2506
2507 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2508 server's queue.
2509
2510 Example of a header received by the application server :
2511 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2512 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2513
2514 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2515
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002516http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002517 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002518 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2519
2520 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2521 no | yes | yes | yes
2522
2523 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2524 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2525 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002526 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2527 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002528 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2529
2530 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2531 instance.
2532
2533 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002534 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2535 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2536 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002537
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002538 http-request allow if nagios
2539 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2540 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2541 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002542
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002543 Example:
2544 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002545
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002546 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002547
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002548 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2549 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002550
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05002551http-send-name-header [<header>]
2552 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
2553
2554 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2555 yes | no | yes | yes
2556
2557 Arguments :
2558
2559 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
2560
2561 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
2562 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
2563 is added with the header string proved.
2564
2565 See also : "server"
2566
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002567id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002568 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2570 no | yes | yes | yes
2571 Arguments : none
2572
2573 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2574 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2575 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002576
2577
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002578ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2579 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2580 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2581 no | yes | yes | yes
2582
2583 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2584 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2585 and running).
2586
2587 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2588 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2589 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2590 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2591 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2592
2593 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2594 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2595
2596 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2597 "unless" condition is met.
2598
2599 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2600
2601
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002602log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002603log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002604no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002605 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2607 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002608
2609 Prefix :
2610 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
2611 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
2612 prefix does not allow arguments.
2613
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002614 Arguments :
2615 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2616 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2617 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2618 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2619 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2620 parameter.
2621
2622 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2623 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2624
2625 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2626 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2627 standard syslog port).
2628
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01002629 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
2630 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2631 standard syslog port).
2632
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002633 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2634 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2635 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2636 appropriately writeable).
2637
2638 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2639
2640 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2641 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2642 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2643
2644 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2645 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2646 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002647 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2648 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2649 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2650 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2651 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002652
2653 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2654
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002655 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
2656 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
2657 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002658
2659 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2660 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2661 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2662 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2663
2664 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2665 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002666
2667 Example :
2668 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002669 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2670 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002671
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01002672log-format <string>
2673 Allows you to custom a log line.
2674
2675 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
2676
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002677
2678maxconn <conns>
2679 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2681 yes | yes | yes | no
2682 Arguments :
2683 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2684 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2685 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2686 closes.
2687
2688 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2689 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2690 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2691 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2692 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2693 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2694 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2695 properly tuned.
2696
2697 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2698 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2699 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2700
2701 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2702
2703
2704mode { tcp|http|health }
2705 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2706 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2707 yes | yes | yes | yes
2708 Arguments :
2709 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2710 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2711 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2712 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2713
2714 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2715 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2716 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2717 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2718 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2719
2720 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2721 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2722 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2723 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2724 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2725 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2726
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002727 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2728 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2729 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002730
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002731 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002732 defaults http_instances
2733 mode http
2734
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002735 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002736
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002737
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002738monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002739 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2741 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002742 Arguments :
2743 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2744 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002745 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002746 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2747 backend and its backup.
2748
2749 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2750 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2751 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2752 servers in a list of backends.
2753
2754 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2755 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2756 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2757 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2758 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2759 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2760 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002761 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
2762 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002763
2764 Example:
2765 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002766 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002767 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2768 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2769 monitor-uri /site_alive
2770 monitor fail if site_dead
2771
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002772 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002773
2774
2775monitor-net <source>
2776 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2778 yes | yes | yes | no
2779 Arguments :
2780 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2781 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2782 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2783 followed by a mask.
2784
2785 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2786 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002787 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002788 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2789
2790 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2791 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2792 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2793 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2794 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2795
2796 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2797 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2798 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2799 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2800 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2801
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002802 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2803 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002804
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002805 Example :
2806 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2807 frontend www
2808 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2809
2810 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2811
2812
2813monitor-uri <uri>
2814 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2816 yes | yes | yes | no
2817 Arguments :
2818 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2819 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2820
2821 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2822 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2823 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2824 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2825 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2826 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2827 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2828 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2829
2830 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2831 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2832 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2833 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2834 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2835 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2836
2837 Example :
2838 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2839 frontend www
2840 mode http
2841 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2842
2843 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2844
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002845
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002846option abortonclose
2847no option abortonclose
2848 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2850 yes | no | yes | yes
2851 Arguments : none
2852
2853 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2854 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2855 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2856 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002857 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002858 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2859 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2860 encountered while delivering the response.
2861
2862 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2863 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2864 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2865 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2866 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2867 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002868 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002869 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002870 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002871 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2872 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2873 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2874
2875 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2876 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2877 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2878 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2879 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2880 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2881 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2882 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002883 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002884
2885 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2886 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2887
2888 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2889
2890
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002891option accept-invalid-http-request
2892no option accept-invalid-http-request
2893 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2895 yes | yes | yes | no
2896 Arguments : none
2897
2898 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2899 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2900 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2901 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2902 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2903 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2904 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2905 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002906 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
2907 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
2908 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
2909 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
2910 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
2911 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002912
2913 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2914 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2915 been confirmed.
2916
2917 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2918 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01002919 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
2920 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002921 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2922
2923 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2924 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2925
2926 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2927 stats socket.
2928
2929
2930option accept-invalid-http-response
2931no option accept-invalid-http-response
2932 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2934 yes | no | yes | yes
2935 Arguments : none
2936
2937 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2938 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2939 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2940 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2941 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2942 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2943 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2944 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2945 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2946
2947 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2948 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2949 been confirmed.
2950
2951 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2952 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2953 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2954 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2955
2956 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2957 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2958
2959 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2960 stats socket.
2961
2962
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002963option allbackups
2964no option allbackups
2965 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2967 yes | no | yes | yes
2968 Arguments : none
2969
2970 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2971 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2972 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2973 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2974 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2975 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2976 order between the backup servers anymore.
2977
2978 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2979 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2980
2981 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2982 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2983
2984
2985option checkcache
2986no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002987 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002988 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2989 yes | no | yes | yes
2990 Arguments : none
2991
2992 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2993 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002994 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002995 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2996 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002997 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002998
2999 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003000 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003001 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003002 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3003 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003004 to the client are :
3005 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003006 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003007 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003008 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3009 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3010 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3011 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3012 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3013 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3014 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3015 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3016 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3017 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3018 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3019
3020 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003021 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003022 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003023 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003024 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3025
3026 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3027 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003028 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003029 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3030
3031 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3032 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3033
3034
3035option clitcpka
3036no option clitcpka
3037 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3039 yes | yes | yes | no
3040 Arguments : none
3041
3042 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3043 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3044 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3045 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3046
3047 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3048 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3049 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3050 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3051
3052 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3053 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3054 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3055 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3056 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3057
3058 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3059
3060 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3061 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3062 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3063
3064 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3065 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3066
3067 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3068
3069
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003070option contstats
3071 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3073 yes | yes | yes | no
3074 Arguments : none
3075
3076 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3077 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3078 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3079 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3080 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3081 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3082 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3083
3084
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003085option dontlog-normal
3086no option dontlog-normal
3087 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3089 yes | yes | yes | no
3090 Arguments : none
3091
3092 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3093 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3094 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3095 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3096 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3097 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3098 logged.
3099
3100 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3101 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3102 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3103
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003104 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003105 logging.
3106
3107
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003108option dontlognull
3109no option dontlognull
3110 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3112 yes | yes | yes | no
3113 Arguments : none
3114
3115 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3116 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3117 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3118 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3119 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3120 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3121 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3122
3123 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3124 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3125 would not be logged.
3126
3127 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3128 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003130 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003131
3132
3133option forceclose
3134no option forceclose
3135 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003137 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003138 Arguments : none
3139
3140 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3141 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3142 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3143 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3144 global session times in the logs.
3145
3146 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003147 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003148 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
3149 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
3150 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
3151 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003152
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003153 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3154 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3155 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3156
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003157 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3158 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3159
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003160 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003161
3162
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003163option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003164 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3166 yes | yes | yes | yes
3167 Arguments :
3168 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3169 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003170 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003171 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003172
3173 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3174 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3175 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3176 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3177 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3178 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3179 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003180 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3181 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3182 possible that the client has already brought one.
3183
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003184 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003185 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003186 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3187 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003188 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3189 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003190
3191 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3192 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3193 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3194 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3195 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3196 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3197 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3198
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003199 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3200 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3201 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3202 are under the control of the end-user.
3203
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003204 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003205 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3206 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003207 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3208 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3209 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003210
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003211 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3212 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3213 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3214 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3215 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003216
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003217 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003218 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3219 frontend www
3220 mode http
3221 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3222
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003223 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3224 backend www
3225 mode http
3226 option forwardfor header X-Client
3227
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003228 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3229 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003230
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003231
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003232option http-no-delay
3233no option http-no-delay
3234 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3236 yes | yes | yes | yes
3237 Arguments : none
3238
3239 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3240 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3241 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3242 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3243 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3244 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3245 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3246 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3247 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3248 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3249 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3250 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3251 affected.
3252
3253 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3254 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3255 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
3256 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
3257 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
3258 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
3259 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
3260 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
3261 latency environments.
3262
3263
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003264option http-pretend-keepalive
3265no option http-pretend-keepalive
3266 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
3267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3268 yes | yes | yes | yes
3269 Arguments : none
3270
3271 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
3272 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
3273 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
3274 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
3275 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
3276 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
3277 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
3278 consider the response complete.
3279
3280 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
3281 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
3282 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
3283 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
3284 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
3285 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
3286
3287 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
3288 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
3289 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
3290 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
3291 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
3292 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
3293 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
3294
3295 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3296 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02003297 This option may be compbined with "option httpclose", which will cause
3298 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
3299 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003300
3301 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3302 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3303
3304 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
3305
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003306
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003307option http-server-close
3308no option http-server-close
3309 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
3310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3311 yes | yes | yes | yes
3312 Arguments : none
3313
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003314 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3315 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
3316 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
3317 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
3318 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
3319 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
3320 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
3321 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
3322 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
3323 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
3324 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
3325 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003326
3327 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3328 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3329 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3330 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003331 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3332 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003333
3334 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3335 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003336 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3337 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3338 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003339
3340 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3341 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3342
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003343 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3344 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003345
3346
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003347option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003348no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003349 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3351 yes | yes | yes | no
3352 Arguments : none
3353
3354 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3355 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3356 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3357 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3358 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3359 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3360 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3361
3362 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3363 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3364 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3365 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3366 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3367 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3368 request along its whole life.
3369
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003370 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3371 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3372 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3373 front of an existing proxy.
3374
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003375 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3376
3377 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3378 http-server-close".
3379
3380
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003381option httpchk
3382option httpchk <uri>
3383option httpchk <method> <uri>
3384option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3385 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3387 yes | no | yes | yes
3388 Arguments :
3389 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3390 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3391 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3392 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3393 ones.
3394
3395 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3396 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3397 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3398
3399 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3400 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3401 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3402 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3403 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3404
3405 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3406 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3407 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3408 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3409 the lack of any response.
3410
3411 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3412
3413 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3414 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3415 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3416
3417 Examples :
3418 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3419 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3420 backend https_relay
3421 mode tcp
3422 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3423 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3424
3425 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003426 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
3427 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003428
3429
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003430option httpclose
3431no option httpclose
3432 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3434 yes | yes | yes | yes
3435 Arguments : none
3436
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003437 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3438 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3439 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3440 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3441 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3442 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3443 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003444
3445 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003446 close the connection eventhough they reply "Connection: close". For this
3447 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3448 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3449 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3450 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3451 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003452
3453 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3454 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3455 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003456 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3457 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003458
3459 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3460 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3461
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003462 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3463 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003464
3465
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003466option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003467 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3469 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003470 Arguments :
3471 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3472 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3473 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3474 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3475 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003476
3477 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3478 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3479 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3480 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3481 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3482 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3483 ports.
3484
3485 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3486
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003487 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3488 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3489 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3490 by default.
3491
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003492 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003493
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003494
3495option http_proxy
3496no option http_proxy
3497 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3499 yes | yes | yes | yes
3500 Arguments : none
3501
3502 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3503 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3504 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3505 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3506 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3507
3508 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3509 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3510 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3511 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01003512 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003513 be analyzed.
3514
3515 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3516 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3517
3518 Example :
3519 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3520 backend direct_forward
3521 option httpclose
3522 option http_proxy
3523
3524 See also : "option httpclose"
3525
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003526
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003527option independant-streams
3528no option independant-streams
3529 Enable or disable independant timeout processing for both directions
3530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3531 yes | yes | yes | yes
3532 Arguments : none
3533
3534 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3535 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3536 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3537 receive data or not.
3538
3539 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3540 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3541 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3542 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3543 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3544 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3545 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3546 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3547 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3548 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3549 socket buffers.
3550
3551 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3552 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3553 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3554 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3555 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3556
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003557 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003558
3559
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003560option ldap-check
3561 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3563 yes | no | yes | yes
3564 Arguments : none
3565
3566 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3567 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3568 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3569 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3570
3571 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3572 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3573
3574 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3575 configure it.
3576
3577 Example :
3578 option ldap-check
3579
3580 See also : "option httpchk"
3581
3582
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003583option log-health-checks
3584no option log-health-checks
3585 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3587 yes | no | yes | yes
3588 Arguments : none
3589
3590 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3591 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3592 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3593 of additional information is limited.
3594
3595 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3596 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3597
3598 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3599
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003600
3601option log-separate-errors
3602no option log-separate-errors
3603 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3605 yes | yes | yes | no
3606 Arguments : none
3607
3608 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3609 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3610 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3611 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3612 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3613 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3614 provides very important information.
3615
3616 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3617 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3618 error logs.
3619
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003620 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003621 logging.
3622
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003623
3624option logasap
3625no option logasap
3626 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3627 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3628 yes | yes | yes | no
3629 Arguments : none
3630
3631 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3632 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3633 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3634 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3635 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3636 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3637 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003638 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003639 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3640 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3641
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003642 Examples :
3643 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3644 mode http
3645 option httplog
3646 option logasap
3647 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3648
3649 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3650 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3651 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3652 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3653
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003654 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003655 logging.
3656
3657
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003658option mysql-check [ user <username> ]
3659 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3661 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003662 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003663 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
3664 server.
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02003665
3666 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
3667 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
3668 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
3669 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
3670 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
3671 in the MySQL table, like this :
3672
3673 USE mysql;
3674 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
3675 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
3676
3677 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
3678 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
3679 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
3680 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
3681 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
3682 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
3683 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
3684 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
3685 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
3686
3687 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
3688 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003689
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02003690 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003691
3692 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3693 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3694 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3695 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3696 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3697 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3698
3699 See also: "option httpchk"
3700
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003701option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
3702 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
3703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3704 yes | no | yes | yes
3705 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003706 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
3707 PostgreSQL server.
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01003708
3709 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
3710 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
3711 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
3712 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
3713
3714 See also: "option httpchk"
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003715
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003716option nolinger
3717no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003718 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003719 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3720 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003721 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003722
3723 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3724 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3725 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3726 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3727 connections.
3728
3729 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3730 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3731 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3732 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3733 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3734 this too.
3735
3736 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3737 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3738 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3739
3740 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3741 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3742 for servers.
3743
3744 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3745 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3746
3747
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003748option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3749 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3751 yes | yes | yes | yes
3752 Arguments :
3753 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3754 matching <network>
3755 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3756 header name.
3757
3758 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3759 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3760 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3761 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3762 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3763 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3764 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3765 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3766 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3767 possible that the client has already brought one.
3768
3769 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3770 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3771 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3772 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3773 header and requires different one.
3774
3775 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3776 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3777 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3778 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3779 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3780 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3781 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3782
3783 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3784 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3785 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3786 both are defined.
3787
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003788 It is important to note that by default, HAProxy works in tunnel mode and
3789 only inspects the first request of a connection, meaning that only the first
3790 request will have the header appended, which is certainly not what you want.
3791 In order to fix this, ensure that any of the "httpclose", "forceclose" or
3792 "http-server-close" options is set when using this option.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003793
3794 Examples :
3795 # Original Destination address
3796 frontend www
3797 mode http
3798 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3799
3800 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3801 backend www
3802 mode http
3803 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3804
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003805 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
3806 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003807
3808
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003809option persist
3810no option persist
3811 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3812 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3813 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003814 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003815
3816 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3817 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3818 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3819 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3820 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3821 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3822 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3823 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3824 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3825 redirected to another valid server.
3826
3827 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3828 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3829
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003830 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003831
3832
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003833option redispatch
3834no option redispatch
3835 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3836 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3837 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003838 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003839
3840 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3841 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3842 be able to access the service anymore.
3843
3844 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3845 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3846
3847 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3848 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3849 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003850
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003851 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3852 "redisp" keywords.
3853
3854 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3855 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3856
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003857 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003858
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003859
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003860option redis-check
3861 Use redis health checks for server testing
3862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3863 yes | no | yes | yes
3864 Arguments : none
3865
3866 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
3867 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
3868 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
3869 find the "+PONG" response message.
3870
3871 Example :
3872 option redis-check
3873
3874 See also : "option httpchk"
3875
3876
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003877option smtpchk
3878option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3879 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3881 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003882 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003883 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3884 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3885 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3886
3887 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3888 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3889 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3890
3891 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3892 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3893 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3894 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3895 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3896 dead server.
3897
3898 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3899 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3900 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3901 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3902
3903 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3904 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3905 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3906 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3907 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3908
3909 Example :
3910 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3911
3912 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3913
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003914
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003915option socket-stats
3916no option socket-stats
3917
3918 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3920 yes | yes | yes | no
3921
3922 Arguments : none
3923
3924
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003925option splice-auto
3926no option splice-auto
3927 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3929 yes | yes | yes | yes
3930 Arguments : none
3931
3932 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3933 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3934 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3935 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003936 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003937 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3938 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3939 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3940 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3941
3942 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3943 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3944 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3945 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3946 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3947 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3948 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3949 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3950 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3951 keyword.
3952
3953 Example :
3954 option splice-auto
3955
3956 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3957 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3958
3959 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3960 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3961
3962
3963option splice-request
3964no option splice-request
3965 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3967 yes | yes | yes | yes
3968 Arguments : none
3969
3970 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3971 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3972 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3973 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3974 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3975 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3976
3977 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3978
3979 Example :
3980 option splice-request
3981
3982 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3983 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3984
3985 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3986 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3987
3988
3989option splice-response
3990no option splice-response
3991 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3993 yes | yes | yes | yes
3994 Arguments : none
3995
3996 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3997 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3998 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3999 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4000 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4001 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4002
4003 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4004
4005 Example :
4006 option splice-response
4007
4008 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4009 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4010
4011 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4012 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4013
4014
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004015option srvtcpka
4016no option srvtcpka
4017 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4019 yes | no | yes | yes
4020 Arguments : none
4021
4022 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4023 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4024 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4025 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4026
4027 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4028 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4029 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4030 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4031
4032 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4033 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4034 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4035 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4036 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4037
4038 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4039
4040 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4041 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4042 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4043
4044 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4045 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4046
4047 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4048
4049
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004050option ssl-hello-chk
4051 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4053 yes | no | yes | yes
4054 Arguments : none
4055
4056 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4057 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4058 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4059 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4060 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4061 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4062 hello message.
4063
4064 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4065 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4066 messages, which is appreciable.
4067
4068 See also: "option httpchk"
4069
4070
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004071option tcp-smart-accept
4072no option tcp-smart-accept
4073 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4075 yes | yes | yes | no
4076 Arguments : none
4077
4078 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4079 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4080 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4081 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4082 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4083 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4084
4085 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4086 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4087 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4088 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4089
4090 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4091 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4092 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4093 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4094
4095 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4096 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
4097 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
4098
4099 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
4100 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
4101 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
4102
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02004103 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
4104
4105
4106option tcp-smart-connect
4107no option tcp-smart-connect
4108 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
4109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4110 yes | no | yes | yes
4111 Arguments : none
4112
4113 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
4114 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
4115 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
4116 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
4117 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
4118
4119 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
4120 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
4121 complex.
4122
4123 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
4124 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
4125 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
4126
4127 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4128 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4129
4130 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
4131
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004132
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004133option tcpka
4134 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
4135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4136 yes | yes | yes | yes
4137 Arguments : none
4138
4139 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4140 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4141 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4142 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4143
4144 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4145 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4146 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4147 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4148
4149 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4150 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4151 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4152 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4153 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4154
4155 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4156
4157 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
4158 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
4159 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
4160 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
4161 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
4162 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
4163 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
4164 backends.
4165
4166 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
4167
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004168
4169option tcplog
4170 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
4171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4172 yes | yes | yes | yes
4173 Arguments : none
4174
4175 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4176 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4177 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
4178 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
4179 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
4180 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
4181 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
4182 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
4183
4184 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4185
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004186 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004187
4188
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004189option transparent
4190no option transparent
4191 Enable client-side transparent proxying
4192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01004193 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004194 Arguments : none
4195
4196 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
4197 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
4198 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
4199 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
4200 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
4201 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
4202 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
4203 appropriate server.
4204
4205 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
4206 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
4207
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01004208 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004209 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004210
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004211
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004212persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004213persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004214 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
4215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4216 yes | no | yes | yes
4217 Arguments :
4218 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004219 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
4220 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004221
4222 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
4223 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
4224 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
4225 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
4226 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
4227 forwarded to this server.
4228
4229 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
4230 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
4231 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004232 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004233 a single "listen" section.
4234
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02004235 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
4236 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
4237 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
4238
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004239 Example :
4240 listen tse-farm
4241 bind :3389
4242 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
4243 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
4244 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
4245 # apply RDP cookie persistence
4246 persist rdp-cookie
4247 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004248 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004249 balance rdp-cookie
4250 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
4251 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
4252
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004253 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
4254 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02004255
4256
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004257rate-limit sessions <rate>
4258 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
4259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4260 yes | yes | yes | no
4261 Arguments :
4262 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
4263 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
4264
4265 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
4266 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
4267 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
4268 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
4269 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
4270 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
4271
4272 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
4273 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
4274 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
4275 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
4276
4277 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
4278 listen smtp
4279 mode tcp
4280 bind :25
4281 rate-limit sessions 10
4282 server 127.0.0.1:1025
4283
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02004284 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
4285 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
4286 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01004287
4288 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
4289
4290
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004291redirect location <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
4292redirect prefix <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004293 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
4294 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4295 no | yes | yes | yes
4296
4297 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01004298 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004299
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004300 Arguments :
4301 <to> With "redirect location", the exact value in <to> is placed into
4302 the HTTP "Location" header. In case of "redirect prefix", the
4303 "Location" header is built from the concatenation of <to> and the
4304 complete URI, including the query string, unless the "drop-query"
Willy Tarreaufe651a52008-11-19 21:15:17 +01004305 option is specified (see below). As a special case, if <to>
4306 equals exactly "/" in prefix mode, then nothing is inserted
4307 before the original URI. It allows one to redirect to the same
4308 URL.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004309
4310 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
4311 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
4312 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
4313 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
4314 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
4315 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
4316 location with a GET method.
4317
4318 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
4319 expected behaviour of a redirection :
4320
4321 - "drop-query"
4322 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
4323 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
4324 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
4325 with a location-type redirect.
4326
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004327 - "append-slash"
4328 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
4329 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
4330 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
4331 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
4332
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004333 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
4334 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
4335 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
4336 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
4337 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
4338 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
4339 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
4340
4341 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
4342 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
4343 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
4344 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
4345 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
4346 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
4347 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004348
4349 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
4350 acl clear dst_port 80
4351 acl secure dst_port 8080
4352 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004353 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004354 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004355 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
4356
4357 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01004358 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
4359 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
4360 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01004361 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004362
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004363 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4364 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4365 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4366
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004367 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004368
4369
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004370redisp (deprecated)
4371redispatch (deprecated)
4372 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4373 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4374 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004375 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004376
4377 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4378 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4379 be able to access the service anymore.
4380
4381 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4382 redistribute them to a working server.
4383
4384 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4385 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4386 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004387
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004388 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4389 "option redispatch" instead.
4390
4391 See also : "option redispatch"
4392
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004393
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004394reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004395 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4397 no | yes | yes | yes
4398 Arguments :
4399 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4400 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004401 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004402
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004403 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4404 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4405
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004406 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4407 the last header of an HTTP request.
4408
4409 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4410 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4411 responses.
4412
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004413 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4414 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4415 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4416
4417 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4418 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004419
4420
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004421reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4422reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004423 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4425 no | yes | yes | yes
4426 Arguments :
4427 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4428 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4429 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4430 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4431 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4432 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4433 ignores case.
4434
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004435 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4436 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4437
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004438 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4439 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4440 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4441 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004442 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004443
4444 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4445 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4446
4447 Example :
4448 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4449 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4450 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4451
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004452 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4453 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004454
4455
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004456reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4457reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004458 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4460 no | yes | yes | yes
4461 Arguments :
4462 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4463 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4464 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4465 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4466 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4467 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4468
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004469 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4470 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4471
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004472 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4473 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4474 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4475 next servers.
4476
4477 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4478 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4479 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4480
4481 Example :
4482 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4483 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4484 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4485
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004486 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4487 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004488
4489
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004490reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4491reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004492 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4494 no | yes | yes | yes
4495 Arguments :
4496 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4497 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4498 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4499 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4500 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4501 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4502 case.
4503
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004504 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4505 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4506
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004507 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4508 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4509 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4510 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004511 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004512
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004513 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004514 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004515 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004516
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004517 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4518 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4519
4520 Example :
4521 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4522 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4523 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4524
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004525 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4526 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004527
4528
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004529reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4530reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004531 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4533 no | yes | yes | yes
4534 Arguments :
4535 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4536 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4537 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4538 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4539 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4540 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4541 case.
4542
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004543 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4544 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4545
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004546 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4547 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4548 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4549 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4550
4551 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4552 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4553
4554 Example :
4555 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4556 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4557 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4558 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4559
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004560 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4561 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004562
4563
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004564reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4565reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004566 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4568 no | yes | yes | yes
4569 Arguments :
4570 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4571 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4572 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4573 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4574 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4575 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4576
4577 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4578 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4579 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4580 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004581 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004582
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004583 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4584 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4585
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004586 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4587 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4588 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4589
4590 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4591 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4592 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4593 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4594 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4595
4596 Example :
4597 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04004598 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004599 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4600 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4601
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004602 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4603 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004604
4605
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004606reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4607reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004608 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4610 no | yes | yes | yes
4611 Arguments :
4612 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4613 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4614 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4615 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4616 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4617 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4618 ignores case.
4619
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004620 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4621 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4622
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004623 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4624 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004625 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4626 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4627 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004628 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4629 not set.
4630
4631 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4632 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4633 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4634 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4635 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4636
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004637 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004638 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4639 # block all others.
4640 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4641 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4642
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004643 # block bad guys
4644 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4645 reqitarpit . if badguys
4646
4647 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4648 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004649
4650
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004651retries <value>
4652 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4653 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4654 yes | no | yes | yes
4655 Arguments :
4656 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4657 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4658 default value is 3.
4659
4660 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4661 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4662 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4663
4664 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4665 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4666
4667 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4668 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4669
4670 See also : "option redispatch"
4671
4672
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004673rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004674 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4676 no | yes | yes | yes
4677 Arguments :
4678 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4679 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004680 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004681
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004682 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4683 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4684
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004685 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4686 the last header of an HTTP response.
4687
4688 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4689 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4690 responses.
4691
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004692 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4693 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004694
4695
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004696rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4697rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004698 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4700 no | yes | yes | yes
4701 Arguments :
4702 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4703 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4704 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4705 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4706 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4707 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4708 ignores case.
4709
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004710 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4711 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4712
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004713 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4714 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004715 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004716 client.
4717
4718 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4719 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4720 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4721
4722 Example :
4723 # remove the Server header from responses
4724 reqidel ^Server:.*
4725
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004726 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4727 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004728
4729
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004730rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4731rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004732 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4734 no | yes | yes | yes
4735 Arguments :
4736 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4737 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4738 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4739 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4740 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4741 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4742 ignores case.
4743
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004744 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4745 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4746
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004747 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4748 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4749 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4750 case-sensitive.
4751
4752 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004753 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4754 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4755 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004756
4757 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4758 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4759
4760 Example :
4761 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4762 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4763
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004764 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4765 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004766
4767
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004768rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4769rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004770 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4772 no | yes | yes | yes
4773 Arguments :
4774 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4775 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4776 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4777 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4778 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4779 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4780 ignores case.
4781
4782 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4783 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4784 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4785 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004786 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004787
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004788 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4789 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4790
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004791 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4792 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4793 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4794
4795 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4796 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4797 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4798 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4799 are not case-sensitive.
4800
4801 Example :
4802 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4803 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4804
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004805 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4806 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004807
4808
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004809server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004810 Declare a server in a backend
4811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4812 no | no | yes | yes
4813 Arguments :
4814 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004815 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-server-name" is
4816 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004817
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01004818 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
4819 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4820 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
4821 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004822 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4823 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4824 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4825 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4826 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4827 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004828
4829 <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
4830 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4831 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4832 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4833 adding this value to the client's port.
4834
4835 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4836 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004837 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004838
4839 Examples :
4840 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4841 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4842
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004843 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
4844 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004845
4846
4847source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004848source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004849source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004850 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4852 yes | no | yes | yes
4853 Arguments :
4854 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4855 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4856 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4857 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4858
4859 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4860 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004861 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4862 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4863 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004864
4865 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4866 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4867 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4868 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4869 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4870 <addr>.
4871
4872 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4873 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4874 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4875 port.
4876
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004877 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4878 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4879 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4880 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4881 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4882 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4883 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4884 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4885 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4886 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4887 HTTP header.
4888
4889 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4890 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
4891 in order to specificy which occurrence to use for the source IP
4892 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4893 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4894 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4895 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4896 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4897 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4898 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4899
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004900 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4901 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4902 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4903 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4904 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4905 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4906
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004907 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4908 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4909 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4910 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4911
4912 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4913 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4914 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4915 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4916 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4917 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4918
4919 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4920 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4921 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4922 there are two methods :
4923
4924 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4925 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4926 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4927 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4928 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4929 of the client ranges may be used.
4930
4931 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4932 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4933 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4934 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4935 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4936 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4937 same session.
4938
4939 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4940 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4941 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4942 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4943 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4944 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4945
4946 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4947 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4948 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004949 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004950
4951 Examples :
4952 backend private
4953 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4954 source 192.168.1.200
4955
4956 backend transparent_ssl1
4957 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4958 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4959
4960 backend transparent_ssl2
4961 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4962 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4963 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4964
4965 backend transparent_ssl3
4966 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4967 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4968 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4969
4970 backend transparent_smtp
4971 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4972 # with Tproxy version 4.
4973 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4974
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004975 backend transparent_http
4976 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4977 # proxy.
4978 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4979
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004980 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004981 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4982
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004983
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004984srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4985 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4987 yes | no | yes | yes
4988 Arguments :
4989 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4990 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4991 as explained at the top of this document.
4992
4993 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4994 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4995 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4996 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4997 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4998 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
4999 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5000
5001 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5002 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5003 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5004 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5005 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005006 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005007 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005008 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005009
5010 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5011 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5012 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5013 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5014 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5015 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5016
5017 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5018 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5019
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005020 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5021 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005022
5023
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005024stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5025 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5027 no | no | yes | yes
5028
5029 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5030 matched.
5031
5032 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5033 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5034
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005035 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5036 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5037 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5038
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005039 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5040 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
5041 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
5042 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005043
5044 Example :
5045 # statistics admin level only for localhost
5046 backend stats_localhost
5047 stats enable
5048 stats admin if LOCALHOST
5049
5050 Example :
5051 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
5052 backend stats_auth
5053 stats enable
5054 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
5055 stats admin if TRUE
5056
5057 Example :
5058 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
5059 userlist stats-auth
5060 group admin users admin
5061 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
5062 group readonly users haproxy
5063 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
5064
5065 backend stats_auth
5066 stats enable
5067 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
5068 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
5069 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
5070 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
5071
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005072 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
5073 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5074 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005075
5076
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005077stats auth <user>:<passwd>
5078 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
5079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5080 yes | no | yes | yes
5081 Arguments :
5082 <user> is a user name to grant access to
5083
5084 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
5085
5086 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
5087 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
5088 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
5089 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
5090 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
5091 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
5092
5093 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
5094 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
5095 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005096 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005097
5098 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
5099 report using "stats scope".
5100
5101 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5102 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5103 unobvious parameters.
5104
5105 Example :
5106 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5107 backend public_www
5108 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5109 stats enable
5110 stats hide-version
5111 stats scope .
5112 stats uri /admin?stats
5113 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5114 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5115 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5116
5117 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5118 backend private_monitoring
5119 stats enable
5120 stats uri /admin?stats
5121 stats refresh 5s
5122
5123 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
5124
5125
5126stats enable
5127 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
5128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5129 yes | no | yes | yes
5130 Arguments : none
5131
5132 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
5133 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
5134 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
5135 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
5136 - stats auth : no authentication
5137 - stats scope : no restriction
5138
5139 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5140 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5141 unobvious parameters.
5142
5143 Example :
5144 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5145 backend public_www
5146 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5147 stats enable
5148 stats hide-version
5149 stats scope .
5150 stats uri /admin?stats
5151 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5152 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5153 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5154
5155 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5156 backend private_monitoring
5157 stats enable
5158 stats uri /admin?stats
5159 stats refresh 5s
5160
5161 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5162
5163
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005164stats hide-version
5165 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5167 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005168 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005169
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005170 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
5171 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
5172 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
5173 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
5174 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
5175 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005176
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005177 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5178 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5179 unobvious parameters.
5180
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005181 Example :
5182 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5183 backend public_www
5184 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02005185 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005186 stats hide-version
5187 stats scope .
5188 stats uri /admin?stats
5189 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5190 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5191 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005192
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005193 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5194 backend private_monitoring
5195 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005196 stats uri /admin?stats
5197 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01005198
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005199 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02005200
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005201
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02005202stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
5203 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5204 Access control for statistics
5205
5206 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5207 no | no | yes | yes
5208
5209 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
5210 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
5211 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
5212 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
5213 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
5214 should be asked to enter a username and password.
5215
5216 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
5217 instance.
5218
5219 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5220 about ACL usage.
5221
5222
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005223stats realm <realm>
5224 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
5225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5226 yes | no | yes | yes
5227 Arguments :
5228 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
5229 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
5230 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
5231
5232 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
5233 using a backslash ('\').
5234
5235 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
5236 only related to authentication.
5237
5238 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5239 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5240 unobvious parameters.
5241
5242 Example :
5243 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5244 backend public_www
5245 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5246 stats enable
5247 stats hide-version
5248 stats scope .
5249 stats uri /admin?stats
5250 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5251 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5252 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5253
5254 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5255 backend private_monitoring
5256 stats enable
5257 stats uri /admin?stats
5258 stats refresh 5s
5259
5260 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
5261
5262
5263stats refresh <delay>
5264 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
5265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5266 yes | no | yes | yes
5267 Arguments :
5268 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
5269 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
5270 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
5271 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
5272 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
5273 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
5274
5275 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
5276 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
5277 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
5278 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
5279
5280 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5281 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5282 unobvious parameters.
5283
5284 Example :
5285 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5286 backend public_www
5287 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5288 stats enable
5289 stats hide-version
5290 stats scope .
5291 stats uri /admin?stats
5292 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5293 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5294 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5295
5296 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5297 backend private_monitoring
5298 stats enable
5299 stats uri /admin?stats
5300 stats refresh 5s
5301
5302 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5303
5304
5305stats scope { <name> | "." }
5306 Enable statistics and limit access scope
5307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5308 yes | no | yes | yes
5309 Arguments :
5310 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
5311 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
5312 section in which the statement appears.
5313
5314 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
5315 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
5316 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
5317 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
5318 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
5319 exists.
5320
5321 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5322 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5323 unobvious parameters.
5324
5325 Example :
5326 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5327 backend public_www
5328 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5329 stats enable
5330 stats hide-version
5331 stats scope .
5332 stats uri /admin?stats
5333 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5334 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5335 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5336
5337 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5338 backend private_monitoring
5339 stats enable
5340 stats uri /admin?stats
5341 stats refresh 5s
5342
5343 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
5344
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005345
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005346stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005347 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
5348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5349 yes | no | yes | yes
5350
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005351 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005352 description from global section is automatically used instead.
5353
5354 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5355 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
5356
5357 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5358 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005359 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005360
5361 Example :
5362 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5363 backend private_monitoring
5364 stats enable
5365 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
5366 stats uri /admin?stats
5367 stats refresh 5s
5368
5369 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
5370 global section.
5371
5372
5373stats show-legends
5374 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
5375 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
5376 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
5377 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
5378 - IP (socket, server)
5379 - cookie (backend, server)
5380
5381 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5382 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005383 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005384
5385 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
5386
5387
5388stats show-node [ <name> ]
5389 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
5390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5391 yes | no | yes | yes
5392 Arguments:
5393 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
5394 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
5395
5396 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
5397 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005398 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005399
5400 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5401 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5402 unobvious parameters.
5403
5404 Example:
5405 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5406 backend private_monitoring
5407 stats enable
5408 stats show-node Europe-1
5409 stats uri /admin?stats
5410 stats refresh 5s
5411
5412 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
5413 section.
5414
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005415
5416stats uri <prefix>
5417 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
5418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5419 yes | no | yes | yes
5420 Arguments :
5421 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5422 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5423 query string.
5424
5425 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5426 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5427 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5428 possible to reach it in the application.
5429
5430 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005431 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005432 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5433 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5434 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5435 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5436
5437 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5438 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5439 an address or a port to statistics only.
5440
5441 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5442 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5443 unobvious parameters.
5444
5445 Example :
5446 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5447 backend public_www
5448 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5449 stats enable
5450 stats hide-version
5451 stats scope .
5452 stats uri /admin?stats
5453 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5454 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5455 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5456
5457 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5458 backend private_monitoring
5459 stats enable
5460 stats uri /admin?stats
5461 stats refresh 5s
5462
5463 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5464
5465
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005466stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5467 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005469 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005470
5471 Arguments :
5472 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5473 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5474 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5475 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5476
5477 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5478 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5479 the "stick-table" statement.
5480
5481 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5482 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5483 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5484 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5485 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5486
5487 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5488 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5489 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5490 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5491 transformation rules.
5492
5493 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5494 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5495 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5496 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5497 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5498 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5499 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5500
5501 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5502 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5503 ACL based conditions.
5504
5505 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5506 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5507 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5508 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5509
5510 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5511 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5512 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5513 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5514
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005515 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5516 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5517 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5518
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005519 Example :
5520 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5521 # last 30 minutes
5522 backend pop
5523 mode tcp
5524 balance roundrobin
5525 stick store-request src
5526 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5527 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5528 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5529
5530 backend smtp
5531 mode tcp
5532 balance roundrobin
5533 stick match src table pop
5534 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5535 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5536
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005537 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5538 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005539
5540
5541stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5542 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5544 no | no | yes | yes
5545
5546 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5547 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5548 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5549 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5550
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005551 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5552 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5553 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5554
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005555 Examples :
5556 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005557 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005558
5559 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5560 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5561 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5562
5563
5564 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5565 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5566 backend http
5567 mode http
5568 balance roundrobin
5569 stick on src table https
5570 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5571 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5572 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5573
5574 backend https
5575 mode tcp
5576 balance roundrobin
5577 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5578 stick on src
5579 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5580 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5581
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005582 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005583
5584
5585stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5586 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5588 no | no | yes | yes
5589
5590 Arguments :
5591 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5592 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5593 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5594 server is selected.
5595
5596 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5597 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5598 the "stick-table" statement.
5599
5600 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5601 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5602 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5603 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5604 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5605 address.
5606
5607 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5608 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5609 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5610 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5611 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5612 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5613 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5614 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5615 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5616 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5617
5618 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5619 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5620 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5621 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5622 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5623 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5624 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5625
5626 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5627 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5628 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5629 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5630
5631 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5632 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5633 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5634 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5635 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5636 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5637 another protocol or access method.
5638
5639 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5640 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5641 the request.
5642
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005643 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5644 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5645 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5646
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005647 Example :
5648 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5649 # last 30 minutes
5650 backend pop
5651 mode tcp
5652 balance roundrobin
5653 stick store-request src
5654 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5655 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5656 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5657
5658 backend smtp
5659 mode tcp
5660 balance roundrobin
5661 stick match src table pop
5662 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5663 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5664
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005665 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
5666 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005667
5668
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005669stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005670 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
5671 [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005672 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005674 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005675
5676 Arguments :
5677 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5678 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5679 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5680 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5681
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01005682 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
5683 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
5684 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5685 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5686
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005687 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5688 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5689 instance.
5690
5691 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5692 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5693 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5694 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5695 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5696 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005697 to 32 characters.
5698
5699 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
5700 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
5701 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5702 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
5703 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
5704 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005705
5706 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02005707 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
5708 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005709 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5710 increase.
5711
5712 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005713 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5714 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5715 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005716
5717 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5718 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5719 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5720 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5721 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5722 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5723 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5724 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5725 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5726 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5727 parameter (see below).
5728
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02005729 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
5730 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
5731 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
5732 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
5733 soft restart.
5734
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005735 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
5736
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005737 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5738 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5739 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5740 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5741 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005742 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005743 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5744 if not expiration delay is specified.
5745
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005746 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5747 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5748 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5749 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005750 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5751 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5752 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5753 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5754 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5755 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5756 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5757 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5758 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5759 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5760 types and their arguments.
5761
5762 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5763 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5764 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5765 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5766
5767 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5768 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5769 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5770 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5771
5772 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5773 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5774 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5775 they were received.
5776
5777 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5778 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5779 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5780 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5781 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5782
5783 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5784 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5785 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5786 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5787 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5788
5789 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5790 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5791 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5792
5793 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5794 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5795 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5796 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5797 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5798
5799 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5800 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5801 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5802 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5803 the client side.
5804
5805 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5806 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5807 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5808 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5809 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5810 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5811 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5812
5813 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5814 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5815 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5816 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5817 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5818 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5819 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5820
5821 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5822 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5823 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5824 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5825 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5826 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5827
5828 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5829 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5830 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5831 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5832
5833 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5834 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5835 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5836 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5837 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5838 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5839 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5840 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5841 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5842 recommended for better fairness.
5843
5844 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5845 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5846 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5847 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5848
5849 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5850 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5851 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5852 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5853 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5854 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5855 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5856 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5857 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5858 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005859
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005860 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5861 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005862 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5863 reference it.
5864
5865 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5866 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5867 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5868 as an exclusive stickiness.
5869
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005870 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5871 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5872 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5873 something that can be ignored.
5874
5875 Example:
5876 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5877 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5878 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5879 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5880
5881 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01005882 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005883
5884
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005885stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5886 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5888 no | no | yes | yes
5889
5890 Arguments :
5891 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5892 describes what elements of the response or connection will
5893 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5894 server is selected.
5895
5896 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5897 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5898 the "stick-table" statement.
5899
5900 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5901 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5902 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
5903 when the response is a SSL server hello.
5904
5905 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5906 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
5907 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
5908 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
5909 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
5910 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005911 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005912 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
5913 rules.
5914
5915 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5916 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5917 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5918 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5919 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5920 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5921 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5922
5923 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
5924 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5925 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
5926 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5927
5928 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
5929 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5930 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5931 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5932 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5933 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5934 another protocol or access method.
5935
5936 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
5937
5938 Example :
5939 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
5940 backend https
5941 mode tcp
5942 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005943 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005944 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005945
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005946 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
5947 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
5948
5949 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
5950 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5951 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
5952
5953 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
5954 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005955
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005956 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
5957 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
5958 # at offset 44.
5959
5960 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
5961 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
5962
5963 # Learn on response if server hello.
5964 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005965
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02005966 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5967 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5968
5969 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5970 extraction.
5971
5972
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005973tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5974 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5976 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005977 Arguments :
5978 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5979 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5980 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005981
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005982 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005983
5984 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5985 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005986 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5987 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5988 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5989 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5990 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5991 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005992
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005993 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5994 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5995 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5996 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005997
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005998 Three types of actions are supported :
5999 - accept :
6000 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6001 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6002 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006003
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006004 - reject :
6005 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6006 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6007 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
6008 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
6009 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
6010 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
6011 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
6012 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
6013 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
6014 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
6015 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
6016 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006017
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006018 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
6019 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
6020 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
6021 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
6022 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
6023 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
6024 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
6025 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
6026 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006027
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006028 These actions take one or two arguments :
6029 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
6030 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
6031 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006032
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006033 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
6034 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
6035 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
6036 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006037
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006038 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
6039 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
6040 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
6041 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
6042 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
6043 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
6044 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
6045 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
6046 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
6047 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006048
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006049 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6050 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6051 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006052
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006053 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
6054 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
6055 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006056
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006057 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006058 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006059 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006060
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006061 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
6062 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
6063 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006064
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006065 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
6066 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6067 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006068
6069 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6070
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006071 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006072
6073
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006074tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6075 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006077 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006078 Arguments :
6079 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6080 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
6081 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006082
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006083 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006084
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006085 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
6086 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6087 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
6088 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
6089 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006090
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006091 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
6092 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
6093 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
6094 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
6095 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
6096 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
6097 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
6098 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
6099 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006100
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006101 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6102 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6103 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6104 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006105
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006106 Three types of actions are supported :
6107 - accept :
6108 - reject :
6109 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006110
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006111 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
6112 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006113
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006114 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
6115 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
6116 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
6117 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
6118 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
6119 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006120
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006121 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006122 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6123 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006124
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006125 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006126 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
6127 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
6128 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
6129 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
6130 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006131
6132 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006133 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
6134 # and reject everything else.
6135 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
6136 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02006137 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006138 tcp-request content reject
6139
6140 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006141 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
6142 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6143 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006144 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006145
6146 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
6147 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
6148 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02006149 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006150 tcp-request content reject
6151
6152 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
6153 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
6154
6155 frontend http
6156 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
6157 # protecting all our sites
6158 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
6159 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
6160 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
6161 ...
6162 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
6163
6164 backend http_dynamic
6165 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
6166 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
6167 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
6168 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
6169 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
6170 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
6171 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006172
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006173 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006174
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006175 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006176
6177
6178tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
6179 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
6180 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006181 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006182 Arguments :
6183 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6184 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6185 as explained at the top of this document.
6186
6187 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
6188 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
6189 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
6190 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
6191 data for at most the specified amount of time.
6192
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02006193 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
6194 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
6195 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
6196 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
6197
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006198 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
6199 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006200 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006201 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01006202 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
6203 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
6204 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
6205 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006206
6207 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
6208 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
6209 it pass through unaffected.
6210
6211 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
6212 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
6213 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006214 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006215 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
6216 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02006217 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
6218 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
6219 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006220
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006221 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006222 "timeout client".
6223
6224
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006225tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6226 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
6227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6228 no | no | yes | yes
6229 Arguments :
6230 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
6231 actions include : "accept", "reject".
6232 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
6233
6234 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
6235
6236 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
6237 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
6238 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
6239 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection delay is
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006240 set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02006241
6242 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
6243
6244 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
6245 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
6246 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
6247 inserted.
6248
6249 Two types of actions are supported :
6250 - accept :
6251 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6252 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6253 the rules evaluation.
6254
6255 - reject :
6256 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
6257 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
6258 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediatly closed.
6259
6260 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
6261 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
6262 for changing the default action to a reject.
6263
6264 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-reponse content"
6265 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has been
6266 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
6267 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
6268 period.
6269
6270 See section 7 about ACL usage.
6271
6272 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
6273
6274
6275tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
6276 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
6277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6278 no | no | yes | yes
6279 Arguments :
6280 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6281 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6282 as explained at the top of this document.
6283
6284 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
6285
6286
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006287timeout check <timeout>
6288 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
6289 established.
6290
6291 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6292 yes | no | yes | yes
6293 Arguments:
6294 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6295 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6296 as explained at the top of this document.
6297
6298 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
6299 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
6300 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
6301 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01006302 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
6303 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
6304 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006305
6306 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
6307 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
6308
6309 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
6310 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006311 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006312
6313 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6314 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6315 forget about it.
6316
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006317 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
6318 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006319
6320
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006321timeout client <timeout>
6322timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6323 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
6324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6325 yes | yes | yes | no
6326 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006327 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006328 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6329 as explained at the top of this document.
6330
6331 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
6332 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6333 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
6334 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
6335 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
6336 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
6337 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
6338 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006339 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006340 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006341 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
6342 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
6343 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006344
6345 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
6346 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6347 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6348 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6349 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6350 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6351
6352 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
6353 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
6354 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6355
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006356 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006357
6358
6359timeout connect <timeout>
6360timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6361 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
6362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6363 yes | no | yes | yes
6364 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006365 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006366 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6367 as explained at the top of this document.
6368
6369 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006370 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006371 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006372 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01006373 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
6374 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006375
6376 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6377 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6378 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6379 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6380 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
6381 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6382
6383 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
6384 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
6385 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6386
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01006387 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
6388 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006389
6390
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006391timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
6392 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
6393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6394 yes | yes | yes | yes
6395 Arguments :
6396 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6397 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6398 as explained at the top of this document.
6399
6400 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
6401 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
6402 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
6403 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
6404 once the request has started to present itself.
6405
6406 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
6407 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
6408 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
6409 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
6410 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
6411
6412 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
6413 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
6414 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
6415 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
6416
6417 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
6418 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
6419 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
6420 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
6421 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02006422 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006423
6424 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
6425 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
6426 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
6427 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
6428
6429 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
6430
6431
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006432timeout http-request <timeout>
6433 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
6434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006435 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006436 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006437 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006438 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6439 as explained at the top of this document.
6440
6441 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
6442 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
6443 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
6444 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
6445 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
6446 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
6447 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
6448 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
6449
6450 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
6451 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006452 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
6453 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006454
6455 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
6456 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
6457 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
6458 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
6459 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
6460
6461 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02006462 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
6463 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
6464 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006465
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006466 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006467
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006468
6469timeout queue <timeout>
6470 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
6471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6472 yes | no | yes | yes
6473 Arguments :
6474 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6475 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6476 as explained at the top of this document.
6477
6478 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
6479 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
6480 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
6481 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
6482 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
6483
6484 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
6485 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
6486 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
6487 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
6488
6489 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6490
6491
6492timeout server <timeout>
6493timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6494 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6496 yes | no | yes | yes
6497 Arguments :
6498 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6499 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6500 as explained at the top of this document.
6501
6502 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6503 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6504 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6505 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6506 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6507 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6508 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6509
6510 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6511 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6512 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6513 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6514 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006515 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006516 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006517 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
6518 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
6519 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
6520 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006521
6522 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6523 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6524 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6525 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6526 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6527 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6528
6529 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
6530 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
6531 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
6532
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006533 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006534
6535
6536timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006537 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6539 yes | yes | yes | yes
6540 Arguments :
6541 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
6542 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6543 as explained at the top of this document.
6544
6545 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
6546 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
6547 defines how long it will be maintained open.
6548
6549 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6550 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6551 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
6552 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006553 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006554
6555 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
6556
6557
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006558timeout tunnel <timeout>
6559 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
6560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6561 yes | no | yes | yes
6562 Arguments :
6563 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6564 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6565 as explained at the top of this document.
6566
6567 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectionnal connection is established
6568 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
6569 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
6570 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
6571 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
6572 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
6573 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
6574 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
6575 specified.
6576
6577 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6578 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6579 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
6580 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
6581 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
6582
6583 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6584 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6585 forget about it.
6586
6587 Example :
6588 defaults http
6589 option http-server-close
6590 timeout connect 5s
6591 timeout client 30s
6592 timeout client 30s
6593 timeout server 30s
6594 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
6595
6596 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server".
6597
6598
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006599transparent (deprecated)
6600 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006602 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006603 Arguments : none
6604
6605 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
6606 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6607 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6608 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6609 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6610 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6611 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6612 appropriate server.
6613
6614 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
6615
6616 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6617 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6618
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006619 See also: "option transparent"
6620
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006621unique-id-format <string>
6622 Generate a unique ID for each request.
6623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6624 yes | yes | yes | no
6625 Arguments :
6626 <string> is a log-format string.
6627
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006628 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
6629 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
6630 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
6631 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006632
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006633 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
6634 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
6635 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
6636 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
6637 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
6638 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
6639 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
6640 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006641
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006642 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
6643 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006644
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006645 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006646
6647 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6648
6649 will generate:
6650
6651 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6652
6653 See also: "unique-id-header"
6654
6655unique-id-header <name>
6656 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
6657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6658 yes | yes | yes | no
6659 Arguments :
6660 <name> is the name of the header.
6661
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006662 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
6663 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006664
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006665 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01006666
6667 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %Ci:%Cp_%Fi:%Fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
6668 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
6669
6670 will generate:
6671
6672 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
6673
6674 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006675
6676use_backend <backend> if <condition>
6677use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006678 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6680 no | yes | yes | no
6681 Arguments :
6682 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
6683
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006684 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006685
6686 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
6687 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
6688 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006689 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
6690 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
6691 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
6692 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006693
6694 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
6695 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
6696 assign the backend.
6697
6698 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
6699 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6700 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
6701 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
6702 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
6703 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6704
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006705 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006706 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006707 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6708 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6709 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6710
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006711 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006712
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006713
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006714use-server <server> if <condition>
6715use-server <server> unless <condition>
6716 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
6717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6718 no | no | yes | yes
6719 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006720 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02006721
6722 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
6723
6724 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
6725 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
6726 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
6727
6728 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
6729 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
6730 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
6731 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
6732 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
6733 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
6734 matches will assign the server.
6735
6736 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
6737 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
6738 with the next rules until one matches.
6739
6740 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
6741 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
6742 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
6743 according to other persistence mechanisms.
6744
6745 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
6746 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
6747 stripped.
6748
6749 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
6750 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
6751 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
6752 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
6753
6754 Example :
6755 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
6756 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
6757 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
6758 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
6759 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
6760 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
6761 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
6762 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
6763 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
6764
6765 See also: "use_backend", serction 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
6766
6767
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010067685. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006769------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006770
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006771The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6772which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6773arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6774settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6775after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6776Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6777address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006778
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006779 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006780 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006781
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006782The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006783
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02006784addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006785 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6786 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6787 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6788 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6789 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006790
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006791 Supported in default-server: No
6792
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006793backup
6794 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6795 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6796 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6797 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6798 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6799 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006800
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006801 Supported in default-server: No
6802
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006803check
6804 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01006805 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
6806 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
6807 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
6808 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
6809 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
6810 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
6811 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
6812 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
6813 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
6814 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006815
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006816 Supported in default-server: No
6817
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006818cookie <value>
6819 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6820 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6821 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6822 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6823 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6824 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6825 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6826
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006827 Supported in default-server: No
6828
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006829disabled
6830 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6831 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6832 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6833 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6834 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6835
6836 Supported in default-server: No
6837
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006838error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006839 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6840 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6841 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006842
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006843 Supported in default-server: Yes
6844
6845 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006846
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006847fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006848 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
6849 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
6850 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
6851
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006852 Supported in default-server: Yes
6853
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006854id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006855 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
6856 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
6857 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006858
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006859 Supported in default-server: No
6860
6861inter <delay>
6862fastinter <delay>
6863downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006864 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
6865 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
6866 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
6867 between checks depending on the server state :
6868
6869 Server state | Interval used
6870 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6871 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
6872 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6873 Transitionally UP (going down), |
6874 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6875 or yet unchecked. |
6876 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6877 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6878 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006879
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006880 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
6881 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
6882 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
6883 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
6884 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
6885 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
6886 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
6887 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
6888 servers.
6889
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006890 Supported in default-server: Yes
6891
6892maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006893 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
6894 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
6895 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
6896 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
6897 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
6898 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
6899 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
6900 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
6901
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006902 Supported in default-server: Yes
6903
6904maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006905 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
6906 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
6907 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
6908 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
6909 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
6910 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
6911 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
6912
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006913 Supported in default-server: Yes
6914
6915minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006916 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
6917 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
6918 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
6919 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
6920 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
6921 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006922 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006923 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006924
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006925 Supported in default-server: Yes
6926
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09006927non-stick
6928 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
6929 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
6930 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
6931
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006932observe <mode>
6933 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
6934 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
6935 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
6936 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
6937 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
6938 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01006939 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006940
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006941 Supported in default-server: No
6942
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006943 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
6944
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006945on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006946 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
6947 Currently, four modes are available:
6948 - fastinter: force fastinter
6949 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
6950 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
6951 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
6952 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
6953
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006954 Supported in default-server: Yes
6955
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006956 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
6957
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09006958on-marked-down <action>
6959 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
6960 Currently one action is available:
6961 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions
6962
6963 Actions are disabled by default
6964
6965 Supported in default-server: Yes
6966
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006967port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006968 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
6969 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
6970 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
6971 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
6972 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
6973 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
6974
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006975 Supported in default-server: Yes
6976
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006977redir <prefix>
6978 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
6979 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
6980 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
6981 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
6982 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
6983 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
6984 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
6985 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006986 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006987 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
6988 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
6989 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
6990 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
6991 loop between the client and HAProxy!
6992
6993 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
6994
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006995 Supported in default-server: No
6996
6997rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006998 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
6999 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
7000 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
7001
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007002 Supported in default-server: Yes
7003
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01007004send-proxy
7005 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
7006 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
7007 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
7008 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
7009 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
7010 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
7011 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
7012 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
7013 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
7014 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. See also the "accept-proxy"
7015 option of the "bind" keyword.
7016
7017 Supported in default-server: No
7018
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007019slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007020 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
7021 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
7022 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
7023 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
7024 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
7025 parameters :
7026
7027 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
7028 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
7029
7030 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
7031 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
7032 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
7033 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
7034
7035 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
7036 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
7037 seen as failed.
7038
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007039 Supported in default-server: Yes
7040
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007041source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007042source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007043source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007044 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
7045 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
7046 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
7047 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
7048
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007049 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
7050 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
7051 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
7052 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
7053 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
7054 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
7055 server.
7056
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007057 Supported in default-server: No
7058
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007059track [<proxy>/]<server>
7060 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
7061 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
7062 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
7063 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
7064 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
7065
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007066 Supported in default-server: No
7067
7068weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007069 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
7070 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
7071 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02007072 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
7073 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
7074 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
7075 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
7076 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
7077 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007078
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01007079 Supported in default-server: Yes
7080
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007081
70826. HTTP header manipulation
7083---------------------------
7084
7085In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
7086response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
7087request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
7088which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
7089against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
7090to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
7091passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
7092headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
7093never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
7094
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007095There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
7096(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
7097rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
7098messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
7099in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007100happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02007101add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
7102normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
7103
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007104This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
7105in section 4.2 :
7106
7107 - reqadd <string>
7108 - reqallow <search>
7109 - reqiallow <search>
7110 - reqdel <search>
7111 - reqidel <search>
7112 - reqdeny <search>
7113 - reqideny <search>
7114 - reqpass <search>
7115 - reqipass <search>
7116 - reqrep <search> <replace>
7117 - reqirep <search> <replace>
7118 - reqtarpit <search>
7119 - reqitarpit <search>
7120 - rspadd <string>
7121 - rspdel <search>
7122 - rspidel <search>
7123 - rspdeny <search>
7124 - rspideny <search>
7125 - rsprep <search> <replace>
7126 - rspirep <search> <replace>
7127
7128With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
7129is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
7130parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
7131prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
7132Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
7133
7134 \t for a tab
7135 \r for a carriage return (CR)
7136 \n for a new line (LF)
7137 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
7138 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
7139 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
7140 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
7141 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
7142
7143The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
7144portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
7145above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
7146regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
71479 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
7148is very common to users of the "sed" program.
7149
7150The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
7151after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
7152
7153Notes related to these keywords :
7154---------------------------------
7155 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
7156 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
7157 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
7158
7159 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
7160 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
7161 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
7162
7163 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
7164 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
7165 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
7166 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
7167 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
7168
7169 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
7170 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
7171 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
7172 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
7173 useless headers before adding new ones.
7174
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007175 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007176 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
7177
7178 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
7179 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
7180 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
7181
7182 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
7183 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007184 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007185
7186
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010071877. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
7188------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007189
7190The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
7191content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
7192from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
7193simple :
7194
7195 - define test criteria with sets of values
7196 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
7197
7198The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
7199
7200In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
7201
7202 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
7203
7204This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
7205Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
7206and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
7207an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
7208of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
7209
7210ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
7211'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
7212which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
7213
7214There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
7215performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
7216
7217The following ACL flags are currently supported :
7218
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007219 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
7220 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007221 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
7222
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007223The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
7224specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
7225possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02007226multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
7227be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
7228needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
7229space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
7230match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
7231lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
7232duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
7233to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceeding it. For
7234instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02007235
7236 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
7237
7238In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
7239the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
7240case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
7241too.
7242
7243Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
7244a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
7245ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
7246
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007247Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007248
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007249 - integers or integer ranges
7250 - strings
7251 - regular expressions
7252 - IP addresses and networks
7253
7254
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020072557.1. Matching integers
7256----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007257
7258Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
7259that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
7260expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
7261may be omitted.
7262
7263For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
7264unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
7265representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
7266
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007267As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
7268two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
7269instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
7270ranges and operators.
7271
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007272For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007273operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
7274Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
7275of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007276
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007277Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007278
7279 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
7280 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
7281 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
7282 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
7283 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
7284
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007285For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007286
7287 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
7288
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007289This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
7290
7291 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
7292
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020072947.2. Matching strings
7295---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007296
7297String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
7298exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
7299characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
7300string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
7301to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007302before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007303
7304
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020073057.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
7306-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007307
7308Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
7309they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
7310possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
7311passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
7312the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007313the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
7314match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007315
7316
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020073177.4. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007318----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007319
7320IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
7321netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
7322within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007323host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007324difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
7325at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
7326does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
7327parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007328
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007329IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
7330Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
7331trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
7332IPv6 patterns.
7333
7334HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
7335following situations :
7336 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
7337 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
7338 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
7339 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
7340 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
7341 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
7342 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
7343 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
7344 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
7345 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
7346
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007347
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020073487.5. Available matching criteria
7349--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007350
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020073517.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
7352------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007353
7354A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
7355analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
7356addresses and ports, as well as internal values independant on the stream.
7357
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007358always_false
7359 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7360 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7361
7362always_true
7363 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
7364 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
7365
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007366avg_queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007367avg_queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007368 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
7369 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
7370 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
7371 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
7372 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
7373 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
7374 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
7375 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
7376 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
7377 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
7378 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01007379
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007380be_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007381be_conn(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007382 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
7383 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
7384 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7385 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
7386 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007387
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007388be_id <integer>
7389 Applies to the backend's id. Can be used in frontends to check from which
7390 backend it was called.
7391
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007392be_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007393be_sess_rate(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007394 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
7395 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
7396 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
7397 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
7398 sucking of an online dictionary).
7399
7400 Example :
7401 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
7402 backend dynamic
7403 mode http
7404 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
7405 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007406
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007407connslots <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007408connslots(<backend>) <integer>
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007409 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007410 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007411 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
7412
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007413 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
7414 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007415
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007416 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007417 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
7418 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
7419 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
7420 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
7421 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007422 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007423
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007424 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
7425 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
7426 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
7427 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08007428
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007429dst <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007430 Applies to the local IPv4 or IPv6 address the client connected to. It can be
7431 used to switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007432
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007433dst_conn <integer>
7434 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
7435 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
7436 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
7437 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
7438 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
7439 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
7440
7441dst_port <integer>
7442 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
7443 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
7444
7445fe_conn <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007446fe_conn(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007447 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
7448 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
7449 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
7450 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
7451 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
7452 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
7453 criteria.
7454
7455fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007456 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007457 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02007458
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007459fe_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007460fe_sess_rate(<frontend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007461 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
7462 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
7463 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
7464 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
7465 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
7466 the rate to go down below the limit.
7467
7468 Example :
7469 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
7470 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
7471 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
7472 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
7473 frontend mail
7474 bind :25
7475 mode tcp
7476 maxconn 100
7477 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
7478 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
7479 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
7480 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007481
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007482nbsrv <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007483nbsrv(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007484 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
7485 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
7486 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
7487 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
7488 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007489
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007490queue <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007491queue(<backend>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007492 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
7493 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
7494 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
7495 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
7496 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
7497 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
7498 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
7499
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007500sc1_bytes_in_rate
7501sc2_bytes_in_rate
7502 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
7503 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7504 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
7505
7506sc1_bytes_out_rate
7507sc2_bytes_out_rate
7508 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
7509 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
7510 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
7511
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007512sc1_clr_gpc0
7513sc2_clr_gpc0
7514 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
7515 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
7516 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. The test
7517 can also be used alone and always returns true. This is typically used as a
7518 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
7519 was verified :
7520
7521 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7522 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7523 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7524 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7525 acl save sc1_clr_gpc0
7526 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7527 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7528
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007529sc1_conn_cnt
7530sc2_conn_cnt
7531 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
7532 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
7533
7534sc1_conn_cur
7535sc2_conn_cur
7536 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
7537 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
7538 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
7539
7540sc1_conn_rate
7541sc2_conn_rate
7542 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
7543 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
7544 See also src_conn_rate.
7545
7546sc1_get_gpc0
7547sc2_get_gpc0
7548 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7549 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
7550
7551sc1_http_err_cnt
7552sc2_http_err_cnt
7553 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
7554 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
7555 See also src_http_err_cnt.
7556
7557sc1_http_err_rate
7558sc2_http_err_rate
7559 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
7560 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
7561 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
7562 src_http_err_rate.
7563
7564sc1_http_req_cnt
7565sc2_http_req_cnt
7566 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7567 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7568 src_http_req_cnt.
7569
7570sc1_http_req_rate
7571sc2_http_req_rate
7572 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
7573 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
7574 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
7575 src_http_req_rate.
7576
7577sc1_inc_gpc0
7578sc2_inc_gpc0
7579 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
7580 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
7581 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
7582 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
7583 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
7584 when a first ACL was verified :
7585
7586 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7587 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
7588 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7589
7590sc1_kbytes_in
7591sc2_kbytes_in
7592 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
7593 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7594 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7595 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
7596
7597sc1_kbytes_out
7598sc2_kbytes_out
7599 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
7600 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
7601 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
7602 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
7603
7604sc1_sess_cnt
7605sc2_sess_cnt
7606 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
7607 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
7608 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
7609 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
7610 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performend over the connection
7611 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
7612
7613sc1_sess_rate
7614sc2_sess_rate
7615 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
7616 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
7617 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
7618 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
7619 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
7620 performend over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
7621
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007622so_id <integer>
7623 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
7624
7625src <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02007626 Applies to the client's IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is usually used to limit
7627 access to certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level
7628 source address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007629
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007630src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007631src_bytes_in_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007632 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7633 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7634 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007635 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007636
7637src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007638src_bytes_out_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007639 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
7640 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7641 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007642 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007643
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +02007644src_clr_gpc0 <integer>
7645src_clr_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
7646 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7647 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7648 stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not found, an
7649 entry is created and 0 is returned. The test can also be used alone and
7650 always returns true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression
7651 in order to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7652
7653 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
7654 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
7655 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7656 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
7657 acl save src_clr_gpc0
7658 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
7659 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
7660
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007661src_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007662src_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007663 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7664 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7665 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007666 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007667
7668src_conn_cur <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007669src_conn_cur(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007670 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
7671 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
7672 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007673 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007674
7675src_conn_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007676src_conn_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007677 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
7678 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7679 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007680 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007681
7682src_get_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007683src_get_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007684 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
7685 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
7686 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007687 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007688
7689src_http_err_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007690src_http_err_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007691 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
7692 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7693 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007694 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007695
7696src_http_err_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007697src_http_err_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007698 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
7699 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
7700 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
7701 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007702 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007703
7704src_http_req_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007705src_http_req_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007706 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7707 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7708 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007709 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007710
7711src_http_req_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007712src_http_req_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007713 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
7714 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7715 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
7716 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007717 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007718
7719src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007720src_inc_gpc0(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007721 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
7722 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
7723 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
7724 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
7725 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
7726 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
7727
7728 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
7729 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007730 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007731
7732src_kbytes_in <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007733src_kbytes_in(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007734 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
7735 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7736 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7737 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007738 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007739
7740src_kbytes_out <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007741src_kbytes_out(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007742 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
7743 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
7744 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
7745 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007746 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007747
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007748src_port <integer>
7749 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01007750
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007751src_sess_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007752src_sess_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007753 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
7754 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
7755 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
7756 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007757 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007758
7759src_sess_rate <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007760src_sess_rate(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007761 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
7762 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
7763 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
7764 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007765 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007766
7767src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007768src_updt_conn_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007769 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007770 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
7771 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007772 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
7773 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
7774 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007775 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007776
7777 Example :
7778 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
7779 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
7780 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
7781 listen ssh
7782 bind :22
7783 mode tcp
7784 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007785 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02007786 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
7787 server local 127.0.0.1:22
7788
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007789srv_conn(<backend>/<server>) <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +02007790 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the server,
7791 possibly including the connection being evaluated.
7792 It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is full.
7793 See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" criteria.
7794
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +01007795srv_id <integer>
7796 Applies to the server's id. Can be used in frontends or backends.
7797
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02007798srv_is_up(<server>)
7799srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
7800 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
7801 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
7802 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
7803 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
7804 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
7805 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
7806 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
7807 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
7808
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007809table_avl <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007810table_avl(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007811 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
7812 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
7813
7814table_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007815table_cnt(<table>) <integer>
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +02007816 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
7817 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
7818 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
7819
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007820
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020078217.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
7822---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007823
7824A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
7825during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007826through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
7827keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007828
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01007829rep_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7830 Returns true when data in the response buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7831 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7832 This test was designed to be used with TCP response content inspection: a
7833 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7834
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007835req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007836 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007837 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
7838 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
7839 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
7840 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
7841 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
7842 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
7843
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007844req_proto_http
7845 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
7846 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007847 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007848 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
7849 using TCP request content inspection rules.
7850
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007851req_rdp_cookie <string>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007852req_rdp_cookie(<name>) <string>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007853 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
7854 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
7855 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
7856 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
7857 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
7858 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
7859 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
7860 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
7861
7862req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007863req_rdp_cookie_cnt(<name>) <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007864 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
7865 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
7866 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
7867 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
7868 cookies.
7869
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +01007870req_ssl_hello_type <integer>
7871 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7872 or superior) hello message and handshake type is equal to <integer>.
7873 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection: an
7874 SSL session ID may be fetched.
7875
7876req_ssl_sni <string>
7877 Returns true when data in the request buffer looks like a complete SSL (v3
7878 or superior) client hello message with a Server Name Indication TLS extension
7879 (SNI) matching <string>. SNI normally contains the name of the host the
7880 client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing
7881 or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This
7882 test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection. If content
7883 switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait for a complete client
7884 hello (type 1), like in the example below.
7885
7886 Examples :
7887 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
7888 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7889 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
7890 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
7891 default_backend bk_sorry_page
7892
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007893req_ssl_ver <decimal>
7894 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
7895 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
7896 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
7897 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
7898 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
7899 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
7900 with TCP request content inspection.
7901
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02007902wait_end
7903 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
7904 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
7905 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
7906 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
7907 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
7908 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
7909 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
7910 inspection.
7911
7912 Examples :
7913 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
7914 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
7915 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
7916
7917 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
7918 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
7919 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
7920 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
7921 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
7922 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
7923 tcp-request content reject
7924
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007925
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079267.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
7927--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007928
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007929A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007930application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
7931read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
7932than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
7933
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02007934cook(<name>) <string>
7935 All "cook*" matching criteria inspect all "Cookie" headers to find a cookie
7936 with the name between parenthesis. If multiple occurrences of the cookie are
7937 found in the request, they will all be evaluated. Spaces around the name and
7938 the value are ignored as requested by the Cookie specification (RFC6265). The
7939 cookie name is case-sensitive. Use the scook() variant for response cookies
7940 sent by the server.
7941
7942 The "cook" criteria returns true if any of the request cookies <name> match
7943 any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For instance,
7944 checking that the "profile" cookie is set to either "silver" or "gold" :
7945
7946 cook(profile) silver gold
7947
7948cook_beg(<name>) <string>
7949 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> begins with one of the
7950 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
7951 scook_beg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
7952
7953cook_cnt(<name>) <integer>
7954 Returns true when the number of occurrences of the specified cookie matches
7955 the values or ranges specified. This is used to detect presence, absence or
7956 abuse of a specific cookie. See "cook" for more information on header
7957 matching. Use the scook_cnt() variant for response cookies sent by the
7958 server.
7959
7960cook_dir(<name>) <string>
7961 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
7962 either isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
7963 directory name matching, though it generally is of limited use with cookies.
7964 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_dir()
7965 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
7966
7967cook_dom(<name>) <string>
7968 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains one of the strings
7969 either isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name
7970 matching. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
7971 scook_dom() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
7972
7973cook_end(<name>) <string>
7974 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> ends with one of the
7975 strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
7976 scook_end() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
7977
7978cook_len(<name>) <integer>
7979 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> has a length which matches
7980 the values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
7981 cookie values. Note that an absent cookie does not match a zero-length test.
7982 See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the scook_len()
7983 variant for response cookies sent by the server.
7984
7985cook_reg(<name>) <regex>
7986 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> matches any of the regular
7987 expressions. It can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that
7988 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also other "cook_" criteria,
7989 as well as "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
7990 scook_reg() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
7991
7992cook_sub(<name>) <string>
7993 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> contains at least one of
7994 the strings. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
7995 scook_sub() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
7996
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +02007997cook_val(<name>) <integer>
7998 Returns true if any of the request cookies <name> starts with a number which
7999 matches the values or ranges specified. This may be used to select a server
8000 based on application-specific cookies. Note that an absent cookie does not
8001 match any value. See "cook" for more information on cookie matching. Use the
8002 scook_val() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
8003
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008004hdr <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008005hdr(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008006 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
8007 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
8008 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
8009 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008010 If an occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, only
8011 this occurrence will be considered. Positive values indicate a position from
8012 the first occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8013 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. Use the shdr()
8014 variant for response headers sent by the server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008015
8016 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008017 match any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values. For
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008018 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
8019
8020 hdr(Connection) -i close
8021
8022hdr_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008023hdr_beg(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008024 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
8025 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
8026 response headers sent by the server.
8027
8028hdr_cnt <integer>
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008029hdr_cnt(<header>) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008030 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
8031 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
8032 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
8033 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
8034 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
8035 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
8036 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8037
8038hdr_dir <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008039hdr_dir(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008040 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8041 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
8042 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
8043 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
8044 headers sent by the server.
8045
8046hdr_dom <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008047hdr_dom(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008048 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
8049 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
8050 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
8051 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
8052 server.
8053
8054hdr_end <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008055hdr_end(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008056 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
8057 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
8058 response headers sent by the server.
8059
8060hdr_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008061hdr_ip(<header>[,<occ>]) <address>
8062 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8063 matching <address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For
8064 or X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008065 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8066
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008067hdr_len <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008068hdr_len(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008069 Returns true when at least one of the headers has a length which matches the
8070 values or ranges specified. This may be used to detect empty or too large
8071 headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
8072 shdr_len() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8073
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008074hdr_reg <regex>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008075hdr_reg(<header>[,<occ>]) <regex>
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +02008076 Returns true it one of the headers matches one of the regular expressions. It
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008077 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
8078 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
8079 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
8080 response headers sent by the server.
8081
8082hdr_sub <string>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008083hdr_sub(<header>[,<occ>]) <string>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008084 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
8085 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
8086 response headers sent by the server.
8087
8088hdr_val <integer>
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008089hdr_val(<header>[,<occ>]) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008090 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
8091 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
8092 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
8093 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
8094
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008095http_auth(<userlist>)
8096http_auth_group(<userlist>) <group> [<group>]*
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008097 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
8098 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
8099 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
8100 of specified groups.
8101
8102 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
8103
Willy Tarreau85c27da2011-09-16 07:53:52 +02008104http_first_req
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +02008105 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
8106 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
8107 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or even to perform
8108 some specific ACL checks only on the first request.
8109
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008110method <string>
8111 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
8112 already check for most common methods.
8113
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008114path <string>
8115 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
8116 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
8117 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
8118
8119path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008120 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
8121 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008122
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008123path_dir <string>
8124 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8125 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8126 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8127 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
8128
8129path_dom <string>
8130 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8131 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
8132 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
8133
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008134path_end <string>
8135 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
8136 control file name extension.
8137
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008138path_len <integer>
8139 Returns true when the path length matches the values or ranges specified.
8140 This may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8141
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008142path_reg <regex>
8143 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8144 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
8145 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
8146
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008147path_sub <string>
8148 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8149 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
8150 "path_dir".
8151
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +02008152payload(<offset>,<length>) <string>
8153 Returns true if the block of <length> bytes, starting at byte <offset> in the
8154 request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of the
8155 strings.
8156
8157payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
8158 Returns true if the block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
8159 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
8160 the request or response buffer (depending on the rule) exactly matches one of
8161 the strings. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
8162 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
8163
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008164req_ver <string>
8165 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
8166 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
8167
8168status <integer>
8169 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
8170 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
8171 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
8172
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008173url <string>
8174 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
8175 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL.
8176
8177url_beg <string>
8178 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
8179 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme.
8180
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008181url_dir <string>
8182 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
8183 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
8184 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
8185 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
8186
8187url_dom <string>
8188 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8189 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
8190 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
8191
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008192url_end <string>
8193 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
8194 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008195
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008196url_ip <address>
8197 Applies to the IPv4 or IPv6 address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP
8198 request. It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local
8199 network. It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008200
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +02008201url_len <integer>
8202 Returns true when the url length matches the values or ranges specified. This
8203 may be used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8204
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008205url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008206 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
8207 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008208 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008209 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01008210
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008211url_reg <regex>
8212 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
8213 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
8214 than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008215
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008216url_sub <string>
8217 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
8218 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01008219
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008220urlp(<name>) <string>
8221 Note: all "urlp*" matching criteria apply to the first occurrence of the
8222 parameter <name> in the query string. The parameter name is case-sensitive.
8223
8224 The "urlp" matching criteria returns true if the designated URL parameter
8225 matches any of the strings. This can be used to check for exact values.
8226
8227urlp_beg(<name>) <string>
8228 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" begins with one of the strings.
8229 This can be used to check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a
8230 protocol scheme.
8231
8232urlp_dir(<name>) <string>
8233 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings
8234 either isolated or delimited with slashes. This is used to perform filename
8235 or directory name matching in a specific URL parameter without the risk of
8236 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "path_dir" and "urlp_sub".
8237
8238urlp_dom(<name>) <string>
8239 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
8240 in the URL parameter "<name>". This is used to perform domain name matching
8241 in a specific URL parameter without the risk of wrong match due to colliding
8242 prefixes. See also "urlp_sub".
8243
8244urlp_end(<name>) <string>
8245 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" ends with one of the strings.
8246
8247urlp_ip(<name>) <ip_address>
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008248 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains an IPv4 or IPv6 address
8249 which matches one of the specified addresses.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008250
8251urlp_len(<name>) <integer>
8252 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" has a length matching the values
8253 or ranges specified. This is used to detect abusive requests for instance.
8254
8255urlp_reg(<name>) <regex>
8256 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" matches one of the regular
8257 expressions. It can be used any time, but it is important to remember that
8258 regex matching is slower than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all
8259 "urlp_" criteria.
8260
8261urlp_sub(<name>) <string>
8262 Returns true when the URL parameter "<name>" contains one of the strings. It
8263 can be used to detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See
8264 also "path_sub" and other "urlp_" criteria.
8265
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020082677.6. Pre-defined ACLs
8268---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008270Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
8271every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008272order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008273
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008274ACL name Equivalent to Usage
8275---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008276FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02008277HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008278HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
8279HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008280HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
8281HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
8282HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
8283HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
8284LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008285METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
8286METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
8287METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
8288METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
8289METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
8290METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02008291RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008292REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008293TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008294WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
8295---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008296
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008297
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020082987.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
8299----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008300
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008301Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
8302combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008304 - AND (implicit)
8305 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
8306 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008307
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008308A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008309
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008310 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008311
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008312Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
8313indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008314
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008315For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
8316"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
8317requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
8318is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008319
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008320 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8321 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
8322 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
8323 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008324
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008325To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
8326and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008327
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008328 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8329 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8330 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
8331 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008332
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008333 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
8334 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
8335 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
8336 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008337
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01008338It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
8339expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
8340be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
8341the braces must be seen as independant words). Example :
8342
8343 The following rule :
8344
8345 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
8346 block if METH_POST missing_cl
8347
8348 Can also be written that way :
8349
8350 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
8351
8352It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
8353to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
8354simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
8355sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
8356good use is the following :
8357
8358 With named ACLs :
8359
8360 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8361 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8362 monitor fail if site_dead
8363
8364 With anonymous ACLs :
8365
8366 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
8367
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008368See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008369
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01008370
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010083717.8. Pattern extraction
8372-----------------------
8373
8374The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
8375response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
8376for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
8377
8378All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
8379"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
8380begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
8381arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
8382much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
8383equivalent used in ACLs.
8384
8385The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
8386
8387 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008388 It is of type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8389 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8390 according to RFC 4291.
8391
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008392 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
8393 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
8394 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008395 type IPv4 and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
8396 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent,
8397 according to RFC 4291.
8398
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008399 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
8400 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
8401 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
8402 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
8403 type integer and only works with such tables.
8404
Willy Tarreau185b5c42012-04-26 15:11:51 +02008405 hdr(<name>[,<occ>])
8406 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
8407 request. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as
8408 a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
8409 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
8410 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the
8411 last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once
Willy Tarreaue428fb72011-12-16 21:50:30 +01008412 converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02008413
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008414 payload(<offset>,<length>)
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008415 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes, and starting
8416 at bytes <offset> in the buffer of request or response (request
8417 on "stick on" or "stick match" or response in on "stick store
8418 response").
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008419
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008420 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>])
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008421 This extracts a binary block. In a first step the size of the
8422 block is read from response or request buffer at <offset>
8423 bytes and considered coded on <length> bytes. In a second step
8424 data of the block are read from buffer at <offset2> bytes
8425 (by default <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize>).
8426 If <offset2> is prefixed by '+' or '-', it is relative to
8427 <lengthoffset> + <lengthsize> else it is absolute.
8428 Ex: see SSL session id example in "stick table" chapter.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008429
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +02008430 src_port This is the source TCP port of the session on the client side,
8431 which is the port the client connected from. It is very unlikely
8432 that this function will be useful but it's available at no cost.
8433 It is of type integer and only works with such tables.
8434
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008435 url_param(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008436 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in
8437 the query string of the request and uses the corresponding value
8438 to match. A typical use is to get sticky session through url
8439 (e.g. http://example.com/foo?JESSIONID=some_id with
8440 url_param(JSESSIONID)), for cases where cookies cannot be used.
David Cournapeau16023ee2010-12-23 20:55:41 +09008441
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008442 rdp_cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008443 This extracts the value of the rdp cookie <name> as a string
8444 and uses this value to match. This enables implementation of
8445 persistence based on the mstshash cookie. This is typically
8446 done if there is no msts cookie present.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008447
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008448 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing
8449 algorithm may be used and thus the distribution of clients
8450 to backend servers is not linked to a hash of the RDP
8451 cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
8452 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconnect" will
8453 lead to a more even distribution of clients to backend
8454 servers than the hash used by "balance rdp-cookie".
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008455
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008456 Example :
8457 listen tse-farm
8458 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
8459 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8460 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8461 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8462 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8463 persist rdp-cookie
8464 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
8465 # This is only useful makes sense if
8466 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
8467 stick-table type string size 204800
8468 stick on rdp_cookie(mstshash)
8469 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8470 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008471
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008472 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie",
8473 "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008474
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008475 cookie(<name>)
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008476 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02008477 "Cookie" header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header
8478 from the response, and uses the corresponding value to match. A
8479 typical use is to get multiple clients sharing a same profile
8480 use the same server. This can be similar to what "appsession"
8481 does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
8482 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008483
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008484 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008485
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008486 set-cookie(<name>)
Willy Tarreau28376d62012-04-26 21:26:10 +02008487 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the
8488 "cookie" fetch which is capable of handling both requests and
8489 responses. This keyword will disappear soon.
8490
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008491 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a
8492 "Set-Cookie" header line from the response and uses the
8493 corresponding value to match. This can be comparable to what
8494 "appsession" does with default options, but with support for
8495 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008496
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008497 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreaub3eb2212011-07-01 16:16:17 +02008498
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008499
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008500The currently available list of transformations include :
8501
8502 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
8503 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8504 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8505
8506 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
8507 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
8508 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
8509
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008510 ipmask(<mask>) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01008511 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
8512 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
8513 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
8514 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
8515
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008516
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085178. Logging
8518----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008519
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008520One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
8521provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
8522very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
8523provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
8524state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008525to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008526headers.
8527
8528In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
8529about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
8530send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
8531
8532 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
8533 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
8534 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
8535 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
8536 at the termination.
8537
8538The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
8539allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
8540as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
8541while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
8542real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
8543delay.
8544
8545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085468.1. Log levels
8547---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008548
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008549TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008550source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008551HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
8552in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
8553track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
8554syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
8555about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008556
8557
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085588.2. Log formats
8559----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008560
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008561HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +09008562and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
8563slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
8564options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008565
8566 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
8567 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
8568 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
8569 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
8570 extents.
8571
8572 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
8573 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
8574 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
8575 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
8576 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
8577
8578 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
8579 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
8580 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
8581 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
8582 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
8583
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008584 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
8585 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
8586 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
8587 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
8588
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008589 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
8590
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008591Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
8592specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
8593field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
8594servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
8595always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
8596identifier.
8597
8598Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
8599 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
8600 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
8601 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
8602 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
8603
8604
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086058.2.1. Default log format
8606-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008607
8608This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
8609as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
8610format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
8611
8612 Example :
8613 listen www
8614 mode http
8615 log global
8616 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8617
8618 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
8619 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
8620 (www/HTTP)
8621
8622 Field Format Extract from the example above
8623 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
8624 2 'Connect from' Connect from
8625 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
8626 4 'to' to
8627 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
8628 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
8629
8630Detailed fields description :
8631 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
8632 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
8633 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
8634 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
8635 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8636 and processed the connection.
8637 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
8638
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008639In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
8640"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
8641connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
8642
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008643It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
8644will eventually disappear.
8645
8646
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086478.2.2. TCP log format
8648---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008649
8650The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
8651is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
8652information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
8653counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
8654emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
8655environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
8656the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
8657sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008658specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
8659not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
8660fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
8661marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008662
8663 Example :
8664 frontend fnt
8665 mode tcp
8666 option tcplog
8667 log global
8668 default_backend bck
8669
8670 backend bck
8671 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8672
8673 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
8674 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
8675 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
8676
8677 Field Format Extract from the example above
8678 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
8679 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
8680 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
8681 4 frontend_name fnt
8682 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
8683 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
8684 7 bytes_read* 212
8685 8 termination_state --
8686 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
8687 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8688
8689Detailed fields description :
8690 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008691 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8692 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8693 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8694 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8695 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008696
8697 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008698 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8699 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8700 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008701
8702 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
8703 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
8704 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
8705 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
8706
8707 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8708 and processed the connection.
8709
8710 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8711 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8712 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
8713 applications.
8714
8715 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8716 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8717 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8718 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
8719 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
8720
8721 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8722 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8723 See "Timers" below for more details.
8724
8725 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8726 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8727 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
8728 "Timers" below for more details.
8729
8730 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8731 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8732 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8733 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8734 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8735 details.
8736
8737 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
8738 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
8739 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
8740 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
8741 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
8742
8743 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8744 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8745 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
8746 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
8747 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
8748 for more details.
8749
8750 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8751 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8752 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
8753 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
8754 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008755 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008756
8757 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8758 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8759 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8760 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8761 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8762 caused by a denial of service attack.
8763
8764 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8765 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8766 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8767 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8768 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8769 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8770 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8771 denial of service attack.
8772
8773 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8774 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8775 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8776 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8777 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8778 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
8779 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
8780 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
8781 be processed than on other servers.
8782
8783 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
8784 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
8785 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
8786 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
8787 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
8788 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
8789 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
8790 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
8791 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
8792 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
8793 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
8794 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
8795 should not be attributed to the logged server.
8796
8797 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8798 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
8799 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
8800 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
8801 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
8802 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
8803 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
8804 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
8805
8806 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
8807 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
8808 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
8809 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
8810 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
8811 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
8812 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
8813 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
8814 occurs.
8815
8816
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020088178.2.3. HTTP log format
8818----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008819
8820The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
8821is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
8822the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
8823are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
8824emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
8825generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
8826"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
8827which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008828frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
8829is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008830
8831Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
8832slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
8833with a star ('*') after the field name below.
8834
8835 Example :
8836 frontend http-in
8837 mode http
8838 option httplog
8839 log global
8840 default_backend bck
8841
8842 backend static
8843 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
8844
8845 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8846 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8847 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008848 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008849
8850 Field Format Extract from the example above
8851 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
8852 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
8853 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
8854 4 frontend_name http-in
8855 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
8856 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
8857 7 status_code 200
8858 8 bytes_read* 2750
8859 9 captured_request_cookie -
8860 10 captured_response_cookie -
8861 11 termination_state ----
8862 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
8863 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
8864 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
8865 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
8866 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008867
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008868
8869Detailed fields description :
8870 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008871 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
8872 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
8873 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
8874 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
8875 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008876
8877 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01008878 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
8879 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
8880 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008881
8882 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
8883 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
8884 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
8885 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
8886 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
8887
8888 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
8889 and processed the connection.
8890
8891 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
8892 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
8893 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
8894
8895 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
8896 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
8897 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
8898 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
8899 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
8900 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
8901
8902 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
8903 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
8904 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
8905 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
8906 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
8907 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
8908
8909 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
8910 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
8911 See "Timers" below for more details.
8912
8913 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
8914 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
8915 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
8916 below for more details.
8917
8918 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
8919 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
8920 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
8921 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
8922 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
8923 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
8924 for more details.
8925
8926 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
8927 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
8928 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
8929 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
8930 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
8931 details.
8932
8933 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
8934 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
8935 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
8936
8937 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
8938 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
8939 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
8940 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
8941 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
8942 overflowing.
8943
8944 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
8945 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
8946 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
8947 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
8948 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
8949 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
8950 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
8951 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8952
8953 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
8954 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
8955 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
8956 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
8957 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
8958 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
8959 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
8960 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
8961
8962 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
8963 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
8964 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
8965 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
8966 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
8967 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
8968 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
8969
8970 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
8971 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
8972 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
8973 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
8974 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008975 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008976 system.
8977
8978 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
8979 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
8980 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
8981 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
8982 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
8983 caused by a denial of service attack.
8984
8985 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
8986 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
8987 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
8988 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
8989 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
8990 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
8991 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
8992 denial of service attack.
8993
8994 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
8995 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
8996 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
8997 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
8998 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
8999 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
9000 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
9001 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
9002 processed than on other servers.
9003
9004 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
9005 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
9006 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
9007 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
9008 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
9009 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
9010 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
9011 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
9012 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
9013 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
9014 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
9015 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
9016 should not be attributed to the logged server.
9017
9018 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9019 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
9020 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
9021 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
9022 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
9023 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
9024 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
9025 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
9026
9027 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
9028 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
9029 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
9030 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
9031 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
9032 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
9033 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
9034 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
9035 occurs.
9036
9037 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
9038 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
9039 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
9040 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
9041 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
9042 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
9043 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
9044 cookies" below for more details.
9045
9046 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
9047 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
9048 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
9049 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
9050 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
9051 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
9052 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
9053 and cookies" below for more details.
9054
9055 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
9056 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
9057 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
9058 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
9059 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
9060 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
9061 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
9062 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
9063
9064
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020090658.2.4. Custom log format
9066------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009067
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009068The directive log-format allows you to custom the logs in http mode and tcp
9069mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009070
9071HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
9072Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
9073separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
9074prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
9075
9076Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
9077variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
9078string formats ("Q").
9079
9080Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
9081HAproxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
9082
9083Flags are :
9084 * Q: quote a string
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009085 * X: hexadecimal represenation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009086
9087 Example:
9088
9089 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
9090 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
9091
9092At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
9093
9094 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %st\ %B\ %cc\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009095 %cs\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009096
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009097the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009098
9099 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}Ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %st\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %Cp\ \
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009100 %ms\ %f\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009101 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %cc\ %cs\ \%hrl\ %hsl
9102
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009103and the default TCP format is defined this way :
9104
9105 log-format %Ci:%Cp\ [%t]\ %f\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
9106 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
9107
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009108Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
9109
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009110 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9111 | H | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
9112 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9113 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
9114 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
9115 | | %B | bytes_read | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009116 | | %Ci | client_ip | IP |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009117 | | %Cp | client_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009118 | | %Bi | backend_source_ip | IP |
William Lallemandb7ff6a32012-03-02 14:35:21 +01009119 | | %Bp | backend_source_port | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009120 | | %Fi | frontend_ip | IP |
9121 | | %Fp | frontend_port | numeric |
9122 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009123 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009124 | | %Si | server_IP | IP |
9125 | | %Sp | server_port | numeric |
9126 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009127 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
9128 | * | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
9129 | * | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009130 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009131 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
9132 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
9133 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
9134 | | %b | backend_name | string |
9135 | | %bc | beconn | numeric |
9136 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
9137 | * | %cc | captured_request_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009138 | * | %rt | http_request_counter | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009139 | * | %cs | captured_response_cookie | string |
9140 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
9141 | | %fc | feconn | numeric |
9142 | * | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
9143 | * | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
9144 | * | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
9145 | * | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
9146 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009147 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009148 | * | %r | http_request | string |
9149 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
9150 | | %s | server_name | string |
9151 | | %sc | srv_conn | numeric |
9152 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
9153 | * | %st | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009154 | | %t | date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009155 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreau6580c062012-03-12 15:09:42 +01009156 | * | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +01009157 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009158
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +02009159*: mode http only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01009160
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091618.3. Advanced logging options
9162-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009163
9164Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
9165just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
9166options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
9167for more information about their usage.
9168
9169
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091708.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
9171------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009172
9173It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
9174haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
9175commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
9176monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
9177ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
9178
9179 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
9180 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
9181 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
9182 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
9183
9184 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
9185 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
9186 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
9187 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
9188 such as other load-balancers.
9189
9190 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
9191 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
9192 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
9193
9194
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020091958.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
9196----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009197
9198The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
9199what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
9200or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
9201"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
9202just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
9203log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
9204after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
9205is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
9206with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
9207with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
9208
9209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092108.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
9211------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009212
9213Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
9214for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
9215"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
9216retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
9217raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
9218a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
9219file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
9220you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
9221"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
9222
9223
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092248.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
9225--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009226
9227Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
9228multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
9229them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
9230"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
9231logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
9232error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
9233and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
9234too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
9235useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
9236alternative.
9237
9238
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020092398.4. Timing events
9240------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009241
9242Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
9243reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
9244the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
9245frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
9246mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
9247
9248 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
9249 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
9250 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
9251 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
9252 the client closes prematurely or times out.
9253
9254 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
9255 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
9256 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
9257 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
9258 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
9259
9260 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
9261 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
9262 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
9263 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
9264 connection never established.
9265
9266 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
9267 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
9268 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
9269 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
9270 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
9271 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
9272 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
9273 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
9274 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
9275 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
9276 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
9277
9278 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
9279 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
9280 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
9281 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
9282 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
9283
9284 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
9285
9286 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
9287 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
9288 negative.
9289
9290These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
9291protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
9292that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009293due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009294close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
9295session has been aborted on timeout.
9296
9297Most common cases :
9298
9299 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
9300 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
9301 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
9302 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
9303 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
9304 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
9305 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
9306 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
9307 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02009308 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
9309 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
9310 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009311
9312 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
9313 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
9314 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
9315 of ms on remote networks.
9316
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009317 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
9318 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
9319 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009320
9321 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
9322 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
9323 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
9324 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
9325 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
9326 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
9327 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
9328 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
9329 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
9330 to the server until another one is released.
9331
9332Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
9333
9334 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
9335 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
9336 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
9337
9338 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
9339 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
9340 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
9341
9342 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
9343 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
9344 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
9345 flags.
9346
9347 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
9348 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
9349 Check the session termination flags, then check the
9350 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
9351 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
9352 the client connection was maintained open.
9353
9354 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
9355 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
9356 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
9357 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
9358
9359
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093608.5. Session state at disconnection
9361-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009362
9363TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
9364"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
93652-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
9366each of which has a special meaning :
9367
9368 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
9369 session to terminate :
9370
9371 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
9372
9373 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
9374 server explicitly refused it.
9375
9376 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
9377 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
9378 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
9379 error in server response which might have caused information leak
9380 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
9381 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
9382
9383 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
9384 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
9385 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
9386 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
9387 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
9388
9389 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
9390 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
9391 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
9392 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
9393 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
9394
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +09009395 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
9396 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
9397
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +02009398 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
9399
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009400 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
9401 send or receive data.
9402
9403 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
9404 send or receive data.
9405
9406 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
9407 with nothing left in the buffers.
9408
9409 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
9410
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01009411 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009412 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
9413
9414 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
9415 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
9416 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
9417 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
9418 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
9419
9420 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
9421 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
9422
9423 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
9424 server (HTTP only).
9425
9426 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
9427
9428 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
9429 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
9430 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
9431
9432 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
9433 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
9434 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
9435
9436 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
9437
9438 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
9439 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
9440
9441 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
9442 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
9443 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
9444
9445 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
9446 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02009447 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
9448 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009449
9450 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
9451 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
9452 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
9453 another server.
9454
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009455 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009456 server.
9457
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009458 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
9459 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
9460 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
9461 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9462
9463 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
9464 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
9465 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
9466 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
9467
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +02009468 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
9469 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
9470 "use-server" rule).
9471
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009472 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9473
9474 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
9475 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
9476
9477 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
9478
9479 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
9480 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
9481 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
9482
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009483 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
9484 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
9485 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
9486 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
9487 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
9488
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009489 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
9490
9491 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
9492 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
9493
9494 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
9495
9496 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
9497
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009498The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
9499was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009500helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
9501starvation, attacks, etc...
9502
9503The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
9504alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
9505easier finding and understanding.
9506
9507 Flags Reason
9508
9509 -- Normal termination.
9510
9511 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
9512 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
9513 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
9514 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
9515
9516 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
9517 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
9518 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
9519 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
9520 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
9521 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009522
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009523 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9524 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009525 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009526
9527 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
9528 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
9529 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
9530
9531 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
9532 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
9533 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
9534 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
9535 the server takes too long to respond.
9536
9537 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
9538 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
9539 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
9540 long a time to respond.
9541
9542 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
9543 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
9544 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
9545 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
9546 and the client.
9547
9548 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
9549 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
9550 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
9551 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
9552 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
9553 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
9554
9555 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
9556 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009557 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
9558 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
9559 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
9560 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009561
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009562 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009563 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
9564 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
9565 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
9566 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
9567 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
9568
9569 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
9570 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
9571 503 or 504 here.
9572
9573 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
9574 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
9575 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
9576 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
9577 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
9578
9579 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
9580 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009581 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009582 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
9583 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
9584
9585 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
9586 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
9587 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
9588 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
9589 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
9590 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
9591 between haproxy and the server.
9592
9593 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
9594 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
9595 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
9596 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
9597 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
9598 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
9599 solution is to fix the application.
9600
9601 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
9602 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
9603 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
9604 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
9605 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
9606 external attacks.
9607
9608 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
9609 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009610 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009611 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
9612 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
9613
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009614 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
9615 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
9616 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
9617 the client.
9618
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009619 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
9620 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
9621 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
9622 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +01009623 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
9624 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
9625 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
9626 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
9627 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009628
9629 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
9630 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
9631 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
9632 returned an HTTP 403 error.
9633
9634 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
9635 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
9636 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
9637 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
9638
9639 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
9640 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
9641 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
9642 only be solved by proper system tuning.
9643
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02009644The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
9645persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
9646important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
9647re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
9648
9649 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
9650
9651 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9652 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
9653 set on a GET request.
9654
9655 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
9656 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
9657 a "server" entry is removed from the configuraton, since its cookie
9658 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
9659
9660 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
9661 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
9662 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
9663
9664 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
9665 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
9666 already got a cookie.
9667
9668 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9669 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
9670 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
9671 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
9672 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
9673
9674 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
9675 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9676 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9677
9678 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
9679 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
9680 new cookie was inserted in the response.
9681
9682 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
9683 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
9684
9685 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
9686 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
9687 then advertised in the response.
9688
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020096908.6. Non-printable characters
9691-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009692
9693In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
9694consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
9695converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
9696prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
9697being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
9698escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
9699is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
9700'}' when logging headers.
9701
9702Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
9703issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
9704containing spaces is "User-Agent".
9705
9706Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
9707the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
9708performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
9709
9710
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020097118.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
9712---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009713
9714Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
9715achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009716section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009717cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
9718the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
9719the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009720locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009721not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
9722user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
9723a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
9724wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
9725
9726 Examples :
9727 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
9728 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
9729
9730 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
9731 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
9732
9733
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020097348.8. Capturing HTTP headers
9735---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009736
9737Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
9738proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
9739the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
9740server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
9741
9742Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
9743response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009744section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009745
9746It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009747time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
9748appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009749are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
9750and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
9751follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
9752request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
9753in the logs.
9754
9755 Example :
9756 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
9757 listen proxy-out
9758 mode http
9759 option httplog
9760 option logasap
9761 log global
9762 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
9763
9764 # log the name of the virtual server
9765 capture request header Host len 20
9766
9767 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
9768 capture request header Content-Length len 10
9769
9770 # log the beginning of the referrer
9771 capture request header Referer len 20
9772
9773 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
9774 capture response header Server len 20
9775
9776 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
9777 capture response header Content-Length len 10
9778
9779 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
9780 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
9781
9782 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
9783 capture response header Via len 20
9784
9785 # log the URL location during a redirection
9786 capture response header Location len 20
9787
9788 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
9789 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
9790 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9791 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
9792 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
9793
9794 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9795 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9796 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9797 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009798 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009799
9800 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
9801 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
9802 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
9803 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
9804 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009805 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009806
9807
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098088.9. Examples of logs
9809---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009810
9811These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
9812them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
9813reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
9814
9815 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
9816 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9817 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9818
9819 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
9820 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
9821
9822 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
9823 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
9824 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
9825
9826 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
9827 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
9828
9829 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
9830 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
9831 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9832
9833 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009834 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009835 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
9836 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
9837
9838 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
9839 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
9840 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
9841
9842 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
9843 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009844 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009845 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
9846 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
9847 to return the 502 and not the server.
9848
9849 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009850 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009851
9852 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
9853 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
9854 Nothing was sent to any server.
9855
9856 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
9857 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
9858
9859 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
9860 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
9861 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
9862 send a 408 return code to the client.
9863
9864 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
9865 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
9866
9867 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
9868 5 seconds ("c----").
9869
9870 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
9871 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009872 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009873
9874 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009875 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009876 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
9877 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
9878 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
9879 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
9880 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009881
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009882
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020098839. Statistics and monitoring
9884----------------------------
9885
9886It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
9887mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
9888CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
9889Unix socket.
9890
9891
98929.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009893---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009894
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +01009895The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
9896page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
9897
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009898 0. pxname: proxy name
9899 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
9900 for server)
9901 2. qcur: current queued requests
9902 3. qmax: max queued requests
9903 4. scur: current sessions
9904 5. smax: max sessions
9905 6. slim: sessions limit
9906 7. stot: total sessions
9907 8. bin: bytes in
9908 9. bout: bytes out
9909 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009910 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009911 12. ereq: request errors
9912 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009913 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009914 15. wretr: retries (warning)
9915 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +01009916 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01009917 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
9918 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
9919 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
9920 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
9921 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
9922 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
9923 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
9924 25. qlimit: queue limit
9925 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
9926 27. iid: unique proxy id
9927 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
9928 29. throttle: warm up status
9929 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
9930 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009931 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +02009932 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
9933 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
9934 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009935 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009936 UNK -> unknown
9937 INI -> initializing
9938 SOCKERR -> socket error
9939 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
9940 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
9941 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
9942 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
9943 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
9944 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
9945 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
9946 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
9947 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
9948 disable-on-404
9949 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
9950 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
9951 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02009952 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
9953 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009954 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
9955 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
9956 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
9957 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
9958 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
9959 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009960 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
9961 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
9962 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
9963 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01009964 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
9965 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009966
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009967
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020099689.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009969-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01009970
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009971The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009972must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
9973is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
9974a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
9975risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
9976followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
9977given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
9978then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
9979to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009980
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02009981It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
9982on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
9983own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01009984
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009985clear counters
9986 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
9987 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
9988 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
9989 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
9990 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
9991
9992clear counters all
9993 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
9994 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
9995 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
9996
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +09009997clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
9998 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
9999
10000 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
10001 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
10002 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
10003 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
10004 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
10005 later after the session ends is usual enough.
10006
10007 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
10008
10009 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
10010 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
10011 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
10012 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
10013 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
10014 the ACLs :
10015
10016 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10017 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10018 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10019 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10020 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10021 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10022
10023 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010024 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
10025 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010026
10027 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010028 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010029 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010030 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10031 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10032 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10033 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010034
10035 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10036
10037 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010038 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010039 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10040 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010041 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10042 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10043 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010044
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010045disable frontend <frontend>
10046 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
10047 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
10048 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
10049 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
10050 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
10051 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
10052 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
10053 on the stats page.
10054
10055 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10056 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10057
10058 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10059 level "admin".
10060
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010061disable server <backend>/<server>
10062 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
10063 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
10064 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
10065 during the maintenance.
10066
10067 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
10068 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
10069
10070 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010071 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010072
10073 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10074 level "admin".
10075
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010076enable frontend <frontend>
10077 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
10078 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
10079 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
10080 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
10081 which was disabled.
10082
10083 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10084 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10085
10086 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10087 level "admin".
10088
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010089enable server <backend>/<server>
10090 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
10091 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
10092
10093 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010094 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010095
10096 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10097 level "admin".
10098
10099get weight <backend>/<server>
10100 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
10101 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
10102 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
10103 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
10104 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010105 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010106
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010107help
10108 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
10109 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010010110
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010111prompt
10112 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
10113 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
10114 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
10115 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
10116 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
10117 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
10118 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
10119 command.
10120
10121quit
10122 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010123
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020010124set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
10125 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any non-null
10126 positive value is allowed, but setting values larger than the global maxconn
10127 does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections were
10128 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
10129 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
10130 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
10131 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10132
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020010133set maxconn global <maxconn>
10134 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
10135 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
10136 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
10137 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
10138 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
10139 setting.
10140
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020010141set rate-limit connections global <value>
10142 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
10143 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
10144 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
10145 is passed in number of connections per second.
10146
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010147set timeout cli <delay>
10148 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
10149 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
10150 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
10151
10152set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
10153 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
10154 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
10155 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
10156 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
10157 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
10158 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
10159 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
10160 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
10161 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
10162 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
10163 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
10164 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
10165 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020010166 numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010167
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010168show errors [<iid>]
10169 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
10170 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020010171 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
10172 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
10173 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010174
10175 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
10176 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
10177 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
10178 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
10179 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
10180 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
10181 are reported too.
10182
10183 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
10184 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
10185 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
10186 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
10187 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
10188 code.
10189
10190 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
10191 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
10192 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
10193 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
10194 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
10195 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
10196 line.
10197
10198 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010199 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
10200 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010201 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
10202 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
10203
10204 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
10205 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
10206 00038 Location: blah\r\n
10207 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
10208 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
10209 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
10210 00204+ minal\r\n
10211 00211 \r\n
10212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010213 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010010214 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
10215 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
10216 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
10217 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
10218 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
10219 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010010220
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010221show info
10222 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
10223
10224show sess
10225 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020010226 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
10227 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
10228
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010010229show sess <id>
10230 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
10231 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10232 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
10233 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
10234 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
10235 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010236
10237show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
10238 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
10239 possible to dump only selected items :
10240 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
10241 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
10242 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
10243 for example:
10244 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
10245 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
10246 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
10247
10248 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010249 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
10250 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010251 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
10252 Release_date: 2009/09/23
10253 Nbproc: 1
10254 Process_num: 1
10255 (...)
10256
10257 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
10258 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
10259 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
10260 (...)
10261 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
10262
10263 $
10264
10265 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
10266 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
10267 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
10268 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010269 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020010270
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010271show table
10272 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
10273 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
10274 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
10275 entries currently in use.
10276
10277 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010278 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010279 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
10280 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010281
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010282show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010283 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
10284 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
10285 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010286 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
10287
10288 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
10289 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
10290 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
10291 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
10292 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
10293
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010294 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
10295 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
10296 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
10297 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
10298 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
10299 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
10300
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090010301
10302 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090010303 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
10304 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010305
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010306 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010307 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010308 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010309 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
10310 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
10311 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10312 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010313
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010314 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010315 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010316 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10317 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010318
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010319 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
10320 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010321 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010322 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10323 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010324
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010325 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
10326 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090010327 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090010328 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
10329 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
10330
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010331 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
10332 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
10333 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
10334 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
10335 time goes, the average event rate drops.
10336
10337 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
10338 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
10339 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020010340 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
10341 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020010342 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
10343 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020010344
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020010345shutdown frontend <frontend>
10346 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
10347 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
10348 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
10349 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
10350 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
10351 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
10352 once it is terminated.
10353
10354 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
10355 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
10356
10357 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
10358 level "admin".
10359
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020010360shutdown session <id>
10361 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
10362 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
10363 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
10364 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
10365 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
10366 flag in the logs.
10367
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020010368shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
10369 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
10370 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
10371 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
10372 'K' flag in the logs.
10373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010374/*
10375 * Local variables:
10376 * fill-column: 79
10377 * End:
10378 */